1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
45 #include <sys/types.h>
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
61 #include "character.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
143 int use_xim
= 0; /* configure --without-xim */
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
151 static int any_help_event_p
;
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window
;
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
159 struct x_display_info
*x_display_list
;
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list
;
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173 extern struct frame
*updating_frame
;
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177 static struct frame
*pending_autoraise_frame
;
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
184 } pending_event_wait
;
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con
;
189 static String Xt_default_resources
[] = {0};
190 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
;
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
;
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph
;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame
;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame
;
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time
;
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251 static Time last_user_time
;
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
257 static int volatile input_signal_count
;
259 static int input_signal_count
;
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
264 static int x_noop_count
;
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt
, Qhyper
, Qmeta
, Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
;
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms
;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1
;
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file
;
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock
;
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class
[] = EMACS_CLASS
;
282 /* XEmbed implementation. */
284 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
288 XEMBED_MAPPED
= 1 << 0
293 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY
= 0,
294 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE
= 1,
295 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE
= 2,
296 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
= 3,
298 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
= 5,
299 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT
= 6,
300 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV
= 7,
302 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON
= 10,
303 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF
= 11,
304 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 12,
305 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 13,
306 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR
= 14
309 /* Used in x_flush. */
311 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*, Colormap
, XColor
*);
312 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
313 static const XColor
*x_color_cells (Display
*, int *);
314 static void x_update_window_end (struct window
*, int, int);
316 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display
*);
317 static struct terminal
*x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*);
318 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*);
319 static void x_update_end (struct frame
*);
320 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*);
321 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*);
322 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*);
323 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame
*);
324 static void frame_highlight (struct frame
*);
325 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*);
326 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*, struct frame
*);
327 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info
*,
328 struct frame
*, struct input_event
*);
329 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*,
330 XEvent
*, struct input_event
*);
331 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*);
332 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*);
333 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*);
334 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int,
335 enum text_cursor_kinds
);
337 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int, GC
);
338 static void x_flush (struct frame
*f
);
339 static void x_update_begin (struct frame
*);
340 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window
*);
341 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row
*);
342 static struct scroll_bar
*x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*, Window
);
343 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
344 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
345 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
347 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*, XPropertyEvent
*);
348 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*);
349 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*, int, int);
350 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
351 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*, XEvent
*,
352 int *, struct input_event
*);
353 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
354 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
355 static SIGTYPE
x_connection_closed (Display
*, const char *);
358 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
361 x_flush (struct frame
*f
)
363 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
364 connection may be broken. */
365 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay
))
371 Lisp_Object rest
, frame
;
372 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest
, frame
)
373 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
374 x_flush (XFRAME (frame
));
376 else if (FRAME_X_P (f
))
377 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
382 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
383 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
384 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
385 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
386 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392 /***********************************************************************
394 ***********************************************************************/
398 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
399 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
407 struct record event_record
[100];
409 int event_record_index
;
412 record_event (char *locus
, int type
)
414 if (event_record_index
== sizeof (event_record
) / sizeof (struct record
))
415 event_record_index
= 0;
417 event_record
[event_record_index
].locus
= locus
;
418 event_record
[event_record_index
].type
= type
;
419 event_record_index
++;
426 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
428 struct x_display_info
*
429 x_display_info_for_display (Display
*dpy
)
431 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
433 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
434 if (dpyinfo
->display
== dpy
)
440 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
443 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame
*f
)
445 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
446 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
447 Window win
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
449 double alpha_min
= 1.0;
452 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
!= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
)
453 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
454 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
455 win
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
;
457 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
462 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
463 alpha_min
= XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
);
464 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
465 alpha_min
= (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
)) / 100.0;
469 else if (alpha
> 1.0)
471 else if (0.0 <= alpha
&& alpha
< alpha_min
&& alpha_min
<= 1.0)
474 opac
= alpha
* OPAQUE
;
476 /* return unless necessary */
481 unsigned long n
, left
;
483 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
484 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
485 0L, 1L, False
, XA_CARDINAL
,
486 &actual
, &format
, &n
, &left
,
489 if (rc
== Success
&& actual
!= None
)
491 XFree ((void *) data
);
492 if (*(unsigned long *)data
== opac
)
501 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
502 XChangeProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
503 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
504 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1L);
509 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
511 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
515 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
517 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
521 /***********************************************************************
522 Starting and ending an update
523 ***********************************************************************/
525 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
526 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
527 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
528 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
529 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
532 x_update_begin (struct frame
*f
)
538 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
539 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
543 x_update_window_begin (struct window
*w
)
545 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
546 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
549 set_output_cursor (&w
->cursor
);
553 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
555 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
556 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 1;
558 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
560 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f
))
561 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
568 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
571 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window
*w
, int x
, int y0
, int y1
)
573 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
576 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID
);
578 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
581 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
582 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, x
, y0
, x
, y1
);
585 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
587 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
588 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
590 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
591 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
592 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
594 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
595 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
599 x_update_window_end (struct window
*w
, int cursor_on_p
, int mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
601 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w
->frame
));
603 if (!w
->pseudo_window_p
)
608 display_and_set_cursor (w
, 1, output_cursor
.hpos
,
610 output_cursor
.x
, output_cursor
.y
);
612 if (draw_window_fringes (w
, 1))
613 x_draw_vertical_border (w
);
618 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
619 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
620 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
622 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
623 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
624 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
627 updated_window
= NULL
;
631 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
635 x_update_end (struct frame
*f
)
637 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
638 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
)->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
642 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
648 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
649 complete update has been performed. The global variable
650 updated_window is not available here. */
653 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*f
)
657 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
659 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
660 || f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
663 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
664 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
,
665 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_x
,
666 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_y
);
667 hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
674 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
675 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
676 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
677 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
678 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
679 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
682 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row
*desired_row
)
684 struct window
*w
= updated_window
;
690 if (!desired_row
->mode_line_p
&& !w
->pseudo_window_p
)
691 desired_row
->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p
= 1;
693 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
694 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
695 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
696 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
697 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
698 overhead is very small. */
699 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
700 && desired_row
->full_width_p
701 && (f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
),
702 width
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
704 && (height
= desired_row
->visible_height
,
707 int y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, desired_row
->y
));
710 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
711 0, y
, width
, height
, False
);
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
713 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - width
,
714 y
, width
, height
, False
);
720 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params
*p
)
722 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
723 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
724 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
725 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
726 struct face
*face
= p
->face
;
728 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
729 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, -1, gc
);
733 int bx
= p
->bx
, by
= p
->by
, nx
= p
->nx
, ny
= p
->ny
;
735 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
736 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
737 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
738 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
740 XSetFillStyle (display
, face
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
742 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->background
);
744 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
745 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
746 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
747 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
748 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
749 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
750 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
)))
753 int sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
757 int left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
758 int width
= (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
)
759 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
763 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
764 if (left
+ width
== p
->x
)
765 bx
= left
+ sb_width
;
766 else if (p
->x
+ p
->wd
== left
)
770 int header_line_height
= WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w
);
772 nx
= width
- sb_width
;
773 by
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (header_line_height
,
775 ny
= row
->visible_height
;
780 if (left
+ width
== bx
)
782 bx
= left
+ sb_width
;
783 nx
+= width
- sb_width
;
785 else if (bx
+ nx
== left
)
786 nx
+= width
- sb_width
;
791 if (bx
>= 0 && nx
> 0)
792 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, face
->gc
, bx
, by
, nx
, ny
);
795 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->foreground
);
801 Pixmap pixmap
, clipmask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
802 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
));
806 bits
= (unsigned char *)(p
->bits
+ p
->dh
);
808 bits
= (unsigned char *)p
->bits
+ p
->dh
;
810 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
812 pixmap
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
, window
, bits
, p
->wd
, p
->h
,
814 ? (p
->overlay_p
? face
->background
815 : f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
817 face
->background
, depth
);
821 clipmask
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
,
822 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
,
825 gcv
.clip_mask
= clipmask
;
826 gcv
.clip_x_origin
= p
->x
;
827 gcv
.clip_y_origin
= p
->y
;
828 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
, &gcv
);
831 XCopyArea (display
, pixmap
, window
, gc
, 0, 0,
832 p
->wd
, p
->h
, p
->x
, p
->y
);
833 XFreePixmap (display
, pixmap
);
837 gcv
.clip_mask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
838 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
, &gcv
);
839 XFreePixmap (display
, clipmask
);
843 XSetClipMask (display
, gc
, None
);
848 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
849 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
850 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
854 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*terminal
)
858 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
859 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
862 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*terminal
)
867 /***********************************************************************
869 ***********************************************************************/
873 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*);
874 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
875 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*,
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
878 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*);
880 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
881 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*);
882 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
883 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
884 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
885 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*, Display
*, Colormap
,
886 unsigned long *, double, int);
887 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*, struct relief
*,
888 double, int, unsigned long);
889 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*);
890 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
891 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*);
892 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
893 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*, Pixmap
);
894 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int,
896 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*, int, int, int, int,
897 int, int, int, int, int, int,
899 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, XRectangle
*);
901 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*);
904 static void x_check_font (struct frame
*, struct font
*);
908 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
914 if (s
->font
== FRAME_FONT (s
->f
)
915 && s
->face
->background
== FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
916 && s
->face
->foreground
== FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
918 s
->gc
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
;
921 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 xgcv
.background
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
926 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
928 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
929 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
930 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
931 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
932 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
;
933 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
934 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
936 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
937 if (xgcv
.background
== s
->face
->background
938 && xgcv
.foreground
== s
->face
->foreground
)
940 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->foreground
;
941 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
944 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
945 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
946 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
948 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
949 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
952 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
953 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
955 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
960 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
963 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
968 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
969 face_id
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (s
->f
)->mouse_face_face_id
;
970 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
972 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, MOUSE_FACE_ID
);
974 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
975 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, s
->first_glyph
->u
.ch
, -1, Qnil
);
977 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, 0, -1, Qnil
);
978 s
->face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
979 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
981 if (s
->font
== s
->face
->font
)
985 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
990 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->background
;
991 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
992 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
993 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
995 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
996 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
999 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
1000 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1002 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
1005 xassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1009 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1010 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1011 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1014 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1016 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1020 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1021 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1027 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
1029 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
)
1031 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1032 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1034 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO
)
1036 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
);
1037 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1039 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
1041 x_set_cursor_gc (s
);
1044 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
)
1046 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
1047 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1049 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1050 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
1052 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1053 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1057 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1058 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1061 /* GC must have been set. */
1062 xassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1066 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1067 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1070 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1072 XRectangle
*r
= s
->clip
;
1073 int n
= get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s
, r
, 2);
1076 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, r
, n
, Unsorted
);
1081 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1082 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string
*src
, struct glyph_string
*dst
)
1091 r
.width
= src
->width
;
1093 r
.height
= src
->height
;
1096 XSetClipRectangles (dst
->display
, dst
->gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
1101 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1104 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1107 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
1108 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
1110 struct font_metrics metrics
;
1112 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1114 unsigned *code
= alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s
->nchars
);
1115 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1118 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++)
1119 code
[i
] = (s
->char2b
[i
].byte1
<< 8) | s
->char2b
[i
].byte2
;
1120 font
->driver
->text_extents (font
, code
, s
->nchars
, &metrics
);
1124 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1126 composition_gstring_width (gstring
, s
->cmp_from
, s
->cmp_to
, &metrics
);
1128 s
->right_overhang
= (metrics
.rbearing
> metrics
.width
1129 ? metrics
.rbearing
- metrics
.width
: 0);
1130 s
->left_overhang
= metrics
.lbearing
< 0 ? - metrics
.lbearing
: 0;
1134 s
->right_overhang
= s
->cmp
->rbearing
- s
->cmp
->pixel_width
;
1135 s
->left_overhang
= - s
->cmp
->lbearing
;
1140 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1143 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
1146 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1147 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
1148 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
1149 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
1153 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1154 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1155 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1156 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1157 contains the first component of a composition. */
1160 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*s
, int force_p
)
1162 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1163 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1164 if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
1166 int box_line_width
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
1170 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1171 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
1172 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
,
1173 s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1174 s
->background_width
,
1175 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1176 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
1177 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1179 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s
->font
) < s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
1180 || s
->font_not_found_p
1181 || s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1184 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1185 s
->background_width
,
1186 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1187 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1193 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1196 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1200 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1201 of S to the right of that box line. */
1202 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1203 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1204 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1208 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1210 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1212 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1214 struct glyph
*g
= s
->first_glyph
+ i
;
1215 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
,
1216 s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
, g
->pixel_width
- 1,
1218 x
+= g
->pixel_width
;
1223 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1224 int boff
= font
->baseline_offset
;
1227 if (font
->vertical_centering
)
1228 boff
= VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font
, s
->f
) - boff
;
1230 y
= s
->ybase
- boff
;
1232 || (s
->background_filled_p
&& s
->hl
!= DRAW_CURSOR
))
1233 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 0);
1235 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 1);
1236 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1237 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1241 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1244 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1247 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1249 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1250 of S to the right of that box line. */
1251 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1252 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1253 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1257 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1258 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1259 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1260 this composition. */
1262 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1263 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1264 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1266 if (s
->cmp_from
== 0)
1267 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
,
1268 s
->width
- 1, s
->height
- 1);
1270 else if (! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
)
1274 for (i
= 0, j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, j
++)
1275 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s
->cmp
, j
) != '\t')
1277 int xx
= x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2];
1278 int yy
= y
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2 + 1];
1280 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
, yy
, 0);
1281 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1282 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
+ 1, yy
, 0);
1287 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1292 for (i
= j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->cmp_to
; i
++)
1294 glyph
= LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring
, i
);
1295 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph
)))
1296 width
+= LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph
);
1299 int xoff
, yoff
, wadjust
;
1303 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1304 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1305 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1308 xoff
= LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph
);
1309 yoff
= LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph
);
1310 wadjust
= LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph
);
1311 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1312 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1313 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
+ 1, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1321 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1322 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1323 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1329 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1332 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1334 struct glyph
*glyph
= s
->first_glyph
;
1338 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1339 of S to the right of that box line. */
1340 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1341 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1342 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1348 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, glyph
++)
1350 char buf
[7], *str
= NULL
;
1351 int len
= glyph
->u
.glyphless
.len
;
1353 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM
)
1356 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display
)
1357 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
))
1361 = (! glyph
->u
.glyphless
.for_no_font
1362 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display
,
1363 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
)
1364 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
)->extras
[0]);
1365 if (STRINGP (acronym
))
1366 str
= SSDATA (acronym
);
1369 else if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE
)
1371 sprintf ((char *) buf
, "%0*X",
1372 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
< 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1373 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
);
1379 int upper_len
= (len
+ 1) / 2;
1382 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1383 for (j
= 0; j
< len
; j
++)
1385 code
= s
->font
->driver
->encode_char (s
->font
, str
[j
]);
1386 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b
+ j
, code
>> 8, code
& 0xFF);
1388 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, upper_len
,
1389 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_xoff
,
1390 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_yoff
,
1392 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, upper_len
, len
,
1393 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_xoff
,
1394 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_yoff
,
1397 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
!= GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE
)
1398 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1399 x
, s
->ybase
- glyph
->ascent
,
1400 glyph
->pixel_width
- 1,
1401 glyph
->ascent
+ glyph
->descent
- 1);
1402 x
+= glyph
->pixel_width
;
1406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1408 static struct frame
*x_frame_of_widget (Widget
);
1409 static Boolean
cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*, XrmValue
*, Cardinal
*,
1410 XrmValue
*, XrmValue
*, XtPointer
*);
1411 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext
, XrmValue
*, XtPointer
,
1412 XrmValue
*, Cardinal
*);
1415 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1416 cannot be determined. */
1418 static struct frame
*
1419 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget
)
1421 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
1425 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget
));
1427 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1428 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1429 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1430 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1431 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget
))
1432 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
1434 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1435 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1436 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
1437 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail
))
1438 && (f
= XFRAME (XCAR (tail
)),
1440 && f
->output_data
.nothing
!= 1
1441 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
))
1442 && f
->output_data
.x
->widget
== widget
)
1449 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1450 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1451 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1452 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1455 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1457 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1458 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, color
);
1462 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1463 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1464 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1465 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1466 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1467 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1470 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1471 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1473 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1474 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
);
1478 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1479 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1481 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args
[] =
1483 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.screen
),
1485 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.colormap
),
1490 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1491 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1493 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1496 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1498 DPY is the display we are working on.
1500 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1501 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1502 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1503 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1505 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1506 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1508 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1509 we allocated the color or not.
1511 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1514 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*dpy
, XrmValue
*args
, Cardinal
*nargs
,
1515 XrmValue
*from
, XrmValue
*to
,
1516 XtPointer
*closure_ret
)
1526 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1527 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1529 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL
, NULL
);
1533 screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1534 cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1535 color_name
= (String
) from
->addr
;
1537 if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultBackground
) == 0)
1539 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1540 pixel
= WhitePixelOfScreen (screen
);
1542 else if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultForeground
) == 0)
1544 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1545 pixel
= BlackPixelOfScreen (screen
);
1547 else if (XParseColor (dpy
, cmap
, color_name
, &color
)
1548 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, &color
))
1550 pixel
= color
.pixel
;
1551 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) True
;
1556 Cardinal nparams
= 1;
1558 params
[0] = color_name
;
1559 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1560 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1561 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1566 if (to
->addr
!= NULL
)
1568 if (to
->size
< sizeof (Pixel
))
1570 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1574 *(Pixel
*) to
->addr
= pixel
;
1578 cvt_string_to_pixel_value
= pixel
;
1579 to
->addr
= (XtPointer
) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1582 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1587 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1588 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1589 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1591 APP is the application context in which we work.
1593 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1594 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1595 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1597 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1600 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app
, XrmValuePtr to
, XtPointer closure
, XrmValuePtr args
,
1605 XtAppWarningMsg (app
, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1607 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1610 else if (closure
!= NULL
)
1612 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1613 Screen
*screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1614 Colormap cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1615 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen
), screen
, cmap
,
1616 (Pixel
*) to
->addr
, 1);
1621 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1624 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1625 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1626 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1627 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1629 static const XColor
*
1630 x_color_cells (Display
*dpy
, int *ncells
)
1632 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1634 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
== NULL
)
1636 Screen
*screen
= dpyinfo
->screen
;
1639 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
1640 = XDisplayCells (dpy
, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen
));
1641 dpyinfo
->color_cells
1642 = (XColor
*) xmalloc (dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
1643 * sizeof *dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1645 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
; ++i
)
1646 dpyinfo
->color_cells
[i
].pixel
= i
;
1648 XQueryColors (dpy
, dpyinfo
->cmap
,
1649 dpyinfo
->color_cells
, dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1652 *ncells
= dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
;
1653 return dpyinfo
->color_cells
;
1657 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1658 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1661 x_query_colors (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*colors
, int ncolors
)
1663 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1665 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
1668 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolors
; ++i
)
1670 unsigned long pixel
= colors
[i
].pixel
;
1671 xassert (pixel
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1672 xassert (dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
].pixel
== pixel
);
1673 colors
[i
] = dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
];
1677 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), colors
, ncolors
);
1681 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1682 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1685 x_query_color (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*color
)
1687 x_query_colors (f
, color
, 1);
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*dpy
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1701 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
);
1704 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1705 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1706 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1707 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1709 unsigned long nearest_delta
= ~0;
1711 const XColor
*cells
= x_color_cells (dpy
, &ncells
);
1713 for (nearest
= i
= 0; i
< ncells
; ++i
)
1715 long dred
= (color
->red
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].red
>> 8);
1716 long dgreen
= (color
->green
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].green
>> 8);
1717 long dblue
= (color
->blue
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].blue
>> 8);
1718 unsigned long delta
= dred
* dred
+ dgreen
* dgreen
+ dblue
* dblue
;
1720 if (delta
< nearest_delta
)
1723 nearest_delta
= delta
;
1727 color
->red
= cells
[nearest
].red
;
1728 color
->green
= cells
[nearest
].green
;
1729 color
->blue
= cells
[nearest
].blue
;
1730 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
);
1734 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1735 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1736 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1737 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1738 XColor
*cached_color
;
1740 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
1741 && (cached_color
= &dpyinfo
->color_cells
[color
->pixel
],
1742 (cached_color
->red
!= color
->red
1743 || cached_color
->blue
!= color
->blue
1744 || cached_color
->green
!= color
->green
)))
1746 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1747 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= NULL
;
1748 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= 0;
1752 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1754 register_color (color
->pixel
);
1755 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1761 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1762 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1763 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame
*f
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1769 gamma_correct (f
, color
);
1770 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), cmap
, color
);
1774 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1775 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1776 get color reference counts right. */
1779 x_copy_color (struct frame
*f
, long unsigned int pixel
)
1783 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1785 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1786 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), &color
);
1788 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1789 register_color (pixel
);
1795 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1796 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1797 get color reference counts right. */
1800 x_copy_dpy_color (Display
*dpy
, Colormap cmap
, long unsigned int pixel
)
1804 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1806 XQueryColor (dpy
, cmap
, &color
);
1807 XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, &color
);
1809 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1810 register_color (pixel
);
1816 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1819 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1820 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1821 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1822 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1823 use an additional additive factor.
1825 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1826 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1827 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1830 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1831 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1832 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1833 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1834 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1835 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1838 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*f
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
, long unsigned int *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1844 /* Get RGB color values. */
1845 color
.pixel
= *pixel
;
1846 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1848 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1849 xassert (factor
>= 0);
1850 new.red
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.red
);
1851 new.green
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.green
);
1852 new.blue
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.blue
);
1854 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1855 bright
= (2 * color
.red
+ 3 * color
.green
+ color
.blue
) / 6;
1857 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1858 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1859 if (bright
< HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
)
1860 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1861 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1863 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1864 double dimness
= 1 - (double)bright
/ HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
;
1865 /* The additive adjustment. */
1866 int min_delta
= delta
* dimness
* factor
/ 2;
1870 new.red
= max (0, new.red
- min_delta
);
1871 new.green
= max (0, new.green
- min_delta
);
1872 new.blue
= max (0, new.blue
- min_delta
);
1876 new.red
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.red
);
1877 new.green
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.green
);
1878 new.blue
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.blue
);
1882 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1883 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1886 if (new.pixel
== *pixel
)
1888 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1889 delta to the RGB values. */
1890 x_free_colors (f
, &new.pixel
, 1);
1892 new.red
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.red
);
1893 new.green
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.green
);
1894 new.blue
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.blue
);
1895 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1906 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1907 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1908 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1909 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1910 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1911 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1914 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*f
, struct relief
*relief
, double factor
, int delta
, long unsigned int default_pixel
)
1917 struct x_output
*di
= f
->output_data
.x
;
1918 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCLineWidth
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1919 unsigned long pixel
;
1920 unsigned long background
= di
->relief_background
;
1921 Colormap cmap
= FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
);
1922 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1923 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1925 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1926 xgcv
.line_width
= 1;
1928 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1929 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1930 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1932 && relief
->allocated_p
)
1934 x_free_colors (f
, &relief
->pixel
, 1);
1935 relief
->allocated_p
= 0;
1938 /* Allocate new color. */
1939 xgcv
.foreground
= default_pixel
;
1941 if (dpyinfo
->n_planes
!= 1
1942 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, dpy
, cmap
, &pixel
, factor
, delta
))
1944 relief
->allocated_p
= 1;
1945 xgcv
.foreground
= relief
->pixel
= pixel
;
1948 if (relief
->gc
== 0)
1950 xgcv
.stipple
= dpyinfo
->gray
;
1952 relief
->gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), mask
, &xgcv
);
1955 XChangeGC (dpy
, relief
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1959 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1962 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1964 struct x_output
*di
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
;
1965 unsigned long color
;
1967 if (s
->face
->use_box_color_for_shadows_p
)
1968 color
= s
->face
->box_color
;
1969 else if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
1971 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0))
1972 color
= IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0);
1977 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1978 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1979 color
= xgcv
.background
;
1982 if (di
->white_relief
.gc
== 0
1983 || color
!= di
->relief_background
)
1985 di
->relief_background
= color
;
1986 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->white_relief
, 1.2, 0x8000,
1987 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1988 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->black_relief
, 0.6, 0x4000,
1989 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1994 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1995 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1996 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1997 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1998 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1999 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2003 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*f
,
2004 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
2005 int raised_p
, int top_p
, int bot_p
, int left_p
, int right_p
,
2006 XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
2008 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
2009 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
2014 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
2016 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
2017 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2019 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2020 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2021 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2028 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2029 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
2030 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
2032 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
2033 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2034 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, top_y
+ i
,
2035 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, top_y
+ i
);
2042 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
2044 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2045 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2047 for (i
= (width
> 1 ? 1 : 0); i
< width
; ++i
)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2049 left_x
+ i
, top_y
+ i
, left_x
+ i
, bottom_y
- i
+ 1);
2052 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2054 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
2056 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
2057 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2061 /* Outermost top line. */
2063 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2064 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
2065 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
2067 /* Outermost left line. */
2069 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
2075 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2076 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), bottom_y
,
2077 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), bottom_y
);
2078 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
2079 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2080 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, bottom_y
- i
,
2081 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, bottom_y
- i
);
2087 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2088 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2089 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2090 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2091 right_x
- i
, top_y
+ i
+ 1, right_x
- i
, bottom_y
- i
);
2094 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2098 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2099 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2100 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2101 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2102 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2103 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2106 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
,
2107 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
2108 int left_p
, int right_p
, XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
2112 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2113 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->box_color
);
2114 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2117 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2118 left_x
, top_y
, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2122 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2123 left_x
, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2126 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2127 left_x
, bottom_y
- width
+ 1, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2131 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2132 right_x
- width
+ 1, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2134 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2135 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2139 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2142 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2144 int width
, left_x
, right_x
, top_y
, bottom_y
, last_x
, raised_p
;
2145 int left_p
, right_p
;
2146 struct glyph
*last_glyph
;
2147 XRectangle clip_rect
;
2149 last_x
= ((s
->row
->full_width_p
&& !s
->w
->pseudo_window_p
)
2150 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s
->w
)
2151 : window_box_right (s
->w
, s
->area
));
2153 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2154 last_glyph
= (s
->cmp
|| s
->img
2156 : s
->first_glyph
+ s
->nchars
- 1);
2158 width
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2159 raised_p
= s
->face
->box
== FACE_RAISED_BOX
;
2161 right_x
= (s
->row
->full_width_p
&& s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2163 : min (last_x
, s
->x
+ s
->background_width
) - 1);
2165 bottom_y
= top_y
+ s
->height
- 1;
2167 left_p
= (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2168 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2170 || s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2171 right_p
= (last_glyph
->right_box_line_p
2172 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2174 || s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2176 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2178 if (s
->face
->box
== FACE_SIMPLE_BOX
)
2179 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2180 left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2183 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2184 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
,
2185 width
, raised_p
, 1, 1, left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2190 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2193 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2196 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2198 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2199 right of that line. */
2200 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2201 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2203 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2205 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2207 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2208 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2209 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2210 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2216 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2217 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2218 trust on the shape extension to be available
2219 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2221 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2224 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2226 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2227 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
;
2228 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
;
2229 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2230 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2232 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2235 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2236 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2237 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2238 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2239 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2240 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2244 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2246 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2249 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2250 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2251 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2252 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2253 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2254 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2256 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2257 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2258 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2259 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2260 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2261 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2262 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2264 int r
= s
->img
->relief
;
2266 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2268 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2269 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2274 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2275 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2276 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2280 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2283 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2285 int x0
, y0
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
, extra
;
2288 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2290 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2291 right of that line. */
2292 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2293 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2295 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2297 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2299 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2300 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2301 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2302 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2304 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2305 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
)
2307 thick
= tool_bar_button_relief
>= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief
: DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF
;
2308 raised_p
= s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
;
2312 thick
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2313 raised_p
= s
->img
->relief
> 0;
2316 extra
= s
->face
->id
== TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2317 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin
) : 0;
2319 x0
= x
- thick
- extra
;
2320 y0
= y
- thick
- extra
;
2321 x1
= x
+ s
->slice
.width
+ thick
- 1 + extra
;
2322 y1
= y
+ s
->slice
.height
+ thick
- 1 + extra
;
2324 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2325 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2326 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, x0
, y0
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
,
2328 s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
== s
->img
->height
,
2330 s
->slice
.x
+ s
->slice
.width
== s
->img
->width
,
2335 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2338 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*s
, Pixmap pixmap
)
2341 int y
= s
->ybase
- s
->y
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2344 right of that line. */
2345 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2346 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2348 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2350 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2352 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2353 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2354 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2355 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2361 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2362 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2363 trust on the shape extension to be available
2364 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2366 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2370 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2371 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
- s
->slice
.x
;
2372 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
- s
->slice
.y
;
2373 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2374 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2376 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2377 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2378 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2379 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2383 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2384 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2385 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2387 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2388 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2389 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2390 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2391 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2392 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2393 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2395 int r
= s
->img
->relief
;
2397 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
- r
, y
- r
,
2398 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2399 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2404 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2405 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2406 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2410 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2411 give the rectangle to draw. */
2414 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
2418 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2419 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2420 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2421 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2424 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2428 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2431 s->x +-------------------------
2434 | +-------------------------
2437 | | +-------------------
2443 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2445 int box_line_hwidth
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2446 int box_line_vwidth
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
2448 Pixmap pixmap
= None
;
2451 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2452 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2453 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
>= s
->img
->height
)
2454 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2456 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2457 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2459 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
2460 if (height
> s
->slice
.height
2464 || s
->img
->pixmap
== 0
2465 || s
->width
!= s
->background_width
)
2469 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2470 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2471 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2472 Screen
*screen
= FRAME_X_SCREEN (s
->f
);
2473 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen
);
2475 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2476 pixmap
= XCreatePixmap (s
->display
, s
->window
,
2477 s
->background_width
,
2480 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2482 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2484 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2487 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2488 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2489 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, - s
->x
, - s
->y
);
2490 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2491 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2492 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2493 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0);
2498 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
,
2500 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2501 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2502 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2503 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2511 if (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2513 x
+= box_line_hwidth
;
2515 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2516 y
+= box_line_vwidth
;
2518 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, s
->background_width
, height
);
2521 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2524 /* Draw the foreground. */
2527 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
);
2528 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2529 XCopyArea (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2530 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
, s
->x
, s
->y
);
2531 XFreePixmap (s
->display
, pixmap
);
2534 x_draw_image_foreground (s
);
2536 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2538 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2539 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
2540 x_draw_image_relief (s
);
2544 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2547 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2549 xassert (s
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
);
2551 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
2552 && !x_stretch_cursor_p
)
2554 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2555 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2556 int width
, background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2559 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2561 int left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2565 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2571 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2573 int right_x
= window_box_right_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2575 if (x
+ background_width
> right_x
)
2576 background_width
-= x
- right_x
;
2577 x
+= background_width
;
2579 width
= min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s
->f
), background_width
);
2580 if (s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2584 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, width
, s
->height
);
2586 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2587 if (width
< background_width
)
2590 int w
= background_width
- width
, h
= s
->height
;
2594 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2598 if (s
->row
->mouse_face_p
2599 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s
->w
))
2601 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
2607 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2608 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
2610 if (s
->face
->stipple
)
2612 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2613 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2614 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2615 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillSolid
);
2620 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2621 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2622 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2623 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2627 else if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
2629 int background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2630 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2632 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2633 except for header line and mode line. */
2634 if (x
< left_x
&& !s
->row
->mode_line_p
)
2636 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2639 if (background_width
> 0)
2640 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, background_width
, s
->height
);
2643 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2647 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2650 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2652 int relief_drawn_p
= 0;
2654 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2655 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2656 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2657 if (s
->next
&& s
->right_overhang
&& !s
->for_overlaps
)
2660 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2662 for (width
= 0, next
= s
->next
;
2663 next
&& width
< s
->right_overhang
;
2664 width
+= next
->width
, next
= next
->next
)
2665 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
!= IMAGE_GLYPH
)
2667 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2668 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next
);
2669 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
)
2670 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next
);
2672 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next
, 1);
2673 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2677 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2678 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
);
2680 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2681 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2682 if (!s
->for_overlaps
2683 && s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2684 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
2685 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
2688 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2689 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2690 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2691 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2694 else if (!s
->clip_head
/* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2696 && ((s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->left_overhang
)
2697 || (s
->next
&& s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->right_overhang
)))
2698 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2699 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2700 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2701 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, s
);
2703 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2705 switch (s
->first_glyph
->type
)
2708 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
);
2712 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
);
2716 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2717 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2719 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 0);
2720 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2723 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH
:
2724 if (s
->for_overlaps
|| (s
->cmp_from
> 0
2725 && ! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
))
2726 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2728 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2729 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2732 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
:
2733 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2734 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2736 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2737 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2744 if (!s
->for_overlaps
)
2746 /* Draw underline. */
2747 if (s
->face
->underline_p
)
2749 unsigned long thickness
, position
;
2752 if (s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->face
->underline_p
)
2754 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2755 thickness
= s
->prev
->underline_thickness
;
2756 position
= s
->prev
->underline_position
;
2760 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2761 if (s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_thickness
> 0)
2762 thickness
= s
->font
->underline_thickness
;
2765 if (x_underline_at_descent_line
)
2766 position
= (s
->height
- thickness
) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2769 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2770 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2771 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2772 specs, and its default is
2774 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2775 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2777 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2778 && s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_position
>= 0)
2779 position
= s
->font
->underline_position
;
2781 position
= (s
->font
->descent
+ 1) / 2;
2783 position
= underline_minimum_offset
;
2785 position
= max (position
, underline_minimum_offset
);
2787 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2788 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2789 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
<= s
->ybase
+ position
)
2790 position
= (s
->height
- 1) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2791 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
< s
->ybase
+ position
+ thickness
)
2792 thickness
= (s
->y
+ s
->height
) - (s
->ybase
+ position
);
2793 s
->underline_thickness
= thickness
;
2794 s
->underline_position
= position
;
2795 y
= s
->ybase
+ position
;
2796 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2797 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2798 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2802 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2803 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2804 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2805 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2806 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2810 /* Draw overline. */
2811 if (s
->face
->overline_p
)
2813 unsigned long dy
= 0, h
= 1;
2815 if (s
->face
->overline_color_defaulted_p
)
2816 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2821 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2822 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->overline_color
);
2823 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2825 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2829 /* Draw strike-through. */
2830 if (s
->face
->strike_through_p
)
2832 unsigned long h
= 1;
2833 unsigned long dy
= (s
->height
- h
) / 2;
2835 if (s
->face
->strike_through_color_defaulted_p
)
2836 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2841 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2842 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->strike_through_color
);
2843 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2845 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2849 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2850 if (!relief_drawn_p
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
)
2851 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2855 struct glyph_string
*prev
;
2857 for (prev
= s
->prev
; prev
; prev
= prev
->prev
)
2858 if (prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
2859 && prev
->x
+ prev
->width
+ prev
->right_overhang
> s
->x
)
2861 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2862 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2863 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= prev
->hl
;
2866 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev
);
2867 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, prev
);
2868 if (prev
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2869 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2871 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2872 XSetClipMask (prev
->display
, prev
->gc
, None
);
2874 prev
->num_clips
= 0;
2880 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2882 for (next
= s
->next
; next
; next
= next
->next
)
2883 if (next
->hl
!= s
->hl
2884 && next
->x
- next
->left_overhang
< s
->x
+ s
->width
)
2886 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2887 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2888 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= next
->hl
;
2891 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2892 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, next
);
2893 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2894 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2896 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2897 XSetClipMask (next
->display
, next
->gc
, None
);
2899 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2904 /* Reset clipping. */
2905 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2909 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2912 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int shift_by
)
2914 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2915 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
2916 x
, y
, width
, height
,
2920 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2924 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*f
, register int n
)
2930 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2931 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2934 x_clear_area (Display
*dpy
, Window window
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int exposures
)
2936 xassert (width
> 0 && height
> 0);
2937 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, exposures
);
2941 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2944 x_clear_frame (struct frame
*f
)
2946 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2948 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f
)));
2949 output_cursor
.hpos
= output_cursor
.vpos
= 0;
2950 output_cursor
.x
= -1;
2952 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2953 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2955 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
2957 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2958 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2959 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
);
2961 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2962 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2963 redisplay, do it here. */
2964 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
2965 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2968 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
2975 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2977 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2978 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2980 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2983 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2984 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2987 timeval_subtract (struct timeval
*result
, struct timeval x
, struct timeval y
)
2989 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2990 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2991 if (x
.tv_usec
< y
.tv_usec
)
2993 int nsec
= (y
.tv_usec
- x
.tv_usec
) / 1000000 + 1;
2994 y
.tv_usec
-= 1000000 * nsec
;
2998 if (x
.tv_usec
- y
.tv_usec
> 1000000)
3000 int nsec
= (y
.tv_usec
- x
.tv_usec
) / 1000000;
3001 y
.tv_usec
+= 1000000 * nsec
;
3005 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3007 result
->tv_sec
= x
.tv_sec
- y
.tv_sec
;
3008 result
->tv_usec
= x
.tv_usec
- y
.tv_usec
;
3010 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3012 return x
.tv_sec
< y
.tv_sec
;
3016 XTflash (struct frame
*f
)
3022 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3023 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3024 GdkWindow
*window
= gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
3027 vals
.foreground
.pixel
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3028 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3029 vals
.function
= GDK_XOR
;
3030 gc
= gdk_gc_new_with_values (window
,
3031 &vals
, GDK_GC_FUNCTION
| GDK_GC_FOREGROUND
);
3032 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3033 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3037 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3038 pixels into background pixels. */
3042 values
.function
= GXxor
;
3043 values
.foreground
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3044 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3046 gc
= XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3047 GCFunction
| GCForeground
, &values
);
3051 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3052 int height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, FRAME_LINES (f
));
3053 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3054 int flash_height
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
3055 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3056 int flash_left
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3057 int flash_right
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3061 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3062 edge it is next to. */
3063 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f
))
3065 case vertical_scroll_bar_left
:
3066 flash_left
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
3069 case vertical_scroll_bar_right
:
3070 flash_right
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
3077 width
= flash_right
- flash_left
;
3079 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3080 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3082 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3084 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3085 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3086 width
, flash_height
);
3087 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3089 (height
- flash_height
3090 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3091 width
, flash_height
);
3095 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3096 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3097 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3098 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3103 struct timeval wakeup
;
3105 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup
);
3107 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3108 wakeup
.tv_usec
+= 150000;
3109 wakeup
.tv_sec
+= (wakeup
.tv_usec
/ 1000000);
3110 wakeup
.tv_usec
%= 1000000;
3112 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3114 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3116 struct timeval current
;
3117 struct timeval timeout
;
3119 EMACS_GET_TIME (current
);
3121 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3122 if (timeval_subtract (¤t
, wakeup
, current
))
3125 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3127 timeout
.tv_usec
= 10000;
3129 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3130 select (0, NULL
, NULL
, NULL
, &timeout
);
3134 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3135 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3137 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3139 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3140 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3141 width
, flash_height
);
3142 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3144 (height
- flash_height
3145 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3146 width
, flash_height
);
3149 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3150 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3151 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3152 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3155 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc
));
3156 #undef XFillRectangle
3158 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
);
3167 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3171 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f
, int invisible
)
3176 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
!= 0)
3177 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3178 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
);
3181 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3182 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
);
3183 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
3188 /* Make audible bell. */
3191 XTring_bell (struct frame
*f
)
3193 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))
3195 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3202 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), 0);
3203 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3210 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3211 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3212 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3213 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3216 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame
*f
, int n
)
3218 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3223 /***********************************************************************
3225 ***********************************************************************/
3227 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3228 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3231 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*f
, int vpos
, int n
)
3237 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3240 x_scroll_run (struct window
*w
, struct run
*run
)
3242 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
3243 int x
, y
, width
, height
, from_y
, to_y
, bottom_y
;
3245 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3246 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3248 window_box (w
, -1, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
);
3250 from_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->current_y
);
3251 to_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->desired_y
);
3252 bottom_y
= y
+ height
;
3256 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3257 line at the bottom. */
3258 if (from_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3259 height
= bottom_y
- from_y
;
3261 height
= run
->height
;
3265 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3267 if (to_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3268 height
= bottom_y
- to_y
;
3270 height
= run
->height
;
3275 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3279 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
3280 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3281 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
3291 /***********************************************************************
3293 ***********************************************************************/
3297 frame_highlight (struct frame
*f
)
3299 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3300 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3301 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3302 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3304 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3305 f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
3307 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3308 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3312 frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*f
)
3314 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3315 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3316 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3317 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3319 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3320 f
->output_data
.x
->border_tile
);
3322 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3323 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3326 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3327 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3328 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3329 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3330 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3333 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
)
3335 struct frame
*old_focus
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3337 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3339 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3340 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3341 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= frame
;
3343 if (old_focus
&& old_focus
->auto_lower
)
3344 x_lower_frame (old_focus
);
3346 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
&& dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
->auto_raise
)
3347 pending_autoraise_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3349 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
3352 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
);
3355 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3356 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3357 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3360 x_focus_changed (int type
, int state
, struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3362 if (type
== FocusIn
)
3364 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
!= frame
)
3366 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
);
3367 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= frame
;
3369 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3370 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3371 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame
)
3372 && CONSP (Vframe_list
)
3373 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
3375 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_IN_EVENT
;
3376 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3380 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
|= state
;
3383 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3384 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3387 else if (type
== FocusOut
)
3389 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
&= ~state
;
3391 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
== frame
)
3393 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
3394 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
3398 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3399 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3401 if (frame
->pointer_invisible
)
3402 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame
, 0);
3406 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3407 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3409 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3412 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3414 struct frame
*frame
;
3416 frame
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xany
.window
);
3420 switch (event
->type
)
3425 struct frame
*focus_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
;
3427 = focus_frame
? focus_frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
: 0;
3429 if (event
->xcrossing
.detail
!= NotifyInferior
3430 && event
->xcrossing
.focus
3431 && ! (focus_state
& FOCUS_EXPLICIT
))
3432 x_focus_changed ((event
->type
== EnterNotify
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3434 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3440 x_focus_changed (event
->type
,
3441 (event
->xfocus
.detail
== NotifyPointer
?
3442 FOCUS_IMPLICIT
: FOCUS_EXPLICIT
),
3443 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3447 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
3449 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
3450 x_focus_changed ((msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3451 FOCUS_EXPLICIT
, dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3458 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3461 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3463 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
);
3466 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3467 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3468 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3470 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3471 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3472 the appropriate X display info. */
3475 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*frame
)
3477 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
));
3481 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3483 struct frame
*old_highlight
= dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
;
3485 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3487 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
3488 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)))
3489 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
))
3490 : dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
);
3491 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
))
3493 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
) = Qnil
;
3494 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3498 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
3500 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
!= old_highlight
)
3503 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight
);
3504 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
3505 frame_highlight (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
);
3511 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3513 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3515 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3517 int min_code
, max_code
;
3520 XModifierKeymap
*mods
;
3522 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= 0;
3523 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= 0;
3524 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3525 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
= 0;
3526 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
= 0;
3528 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo
->display
, &min_code
, &max_code
);
3530 syms
= XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo
->display
,
3531 min_code
, max_code
- min_code
+ 1,
3533 mods
= XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo
->display
);
3535 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3536 Alt keysyms are on. */
3538 int row
, col
; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3539 int found_alt_or_meta
;
3541 for (row
= 3; row
< 8; row
++)
3543 found_alt_or_meta
= 0;
3544 for (col
= 0; col
< mods
->max_keypermod
; col
++)
3546 KeyCode code
= mods
->modifiermap
[(row
* mods
->max_keypermod
) + col
];
3548 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3552 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3556 for (code_col
= 0; code_col
< syms_per_code
; code_col
++)
3558 int sym
= syms
[((code
- min_code
) * syms_per_code
) + code_col
];
3564 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3565 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3570 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3571 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3576 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3577 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3578 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3579 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3584 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3585 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3586 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3587 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3591 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3592 if (!found_alt_or_meta
&& ((1 << row
) == LockMask
))
3593 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= LockMask
;
3594 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3595 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3604 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3605 if (! dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3607 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
;
3608 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3611 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3612 make them just meta, not alt. */
3613 if (dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3615 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
&= ~dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
;
3618 XFree ((char *) syms
);
3619 XFreeModifiermap (mods
);
3622 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3626 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, unsigned int state
)
3628 EMACS_UINT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3629 EMACS_UINT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3630 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3631 EMACS_UINT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3634 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3635 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_alt
= XUINT (tem
);
3636 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3637 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_meta
= XUINT (tem
);
3638 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3639 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_hyper
= XUINT (tem
);
3640 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3641 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_super
= XUINT (tem
);
3644 return ( ((state
& (ShiftMask
| dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
)) ? shift_modifier
: 0)
3645 | ((state
& ControlMask
) ? ctrl_modifier
: 0)
3646 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
) ? mod_meta
: 0)
3647 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
) ? mod_alt
: 0)
3648 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
) ? mod_super
: 0)
3649 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
) ? mod_hyper
: 0));
3653 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, unsigned int state
)
3655 EMACS_UINT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3656 EMACS_UINT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3657 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3658 EMACS_UINT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3662 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3663 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_alt
= XUINT (tem
);
3664 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3665 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_meta
= XUINT (tem
);
3666 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3667 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_hyper
= XUINT (tem
);
3668 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3669 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_super
= XUINT (tem
);
3672 return ( ((state
& mod_alt
) ? dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
: 0)
3673 | ((state
& mod_super
) ? dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
: 0)
3674 | ((state
& mod_hyper
) ? dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
: 0)
3675 | ((state
& shift_modifier
) ? ShiftMask
: 0)
3676 | ((state
& ctrl_modifier
) ? ControlMask
: 0)
3677 | ((state
& mod_meta
) ? dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
: 0));
3680 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3683 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym
)
3688 value
= XKeysymToString (keysym
);
3696 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3698 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3700 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3704 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event
*result
, XButtonEvent
*event
, struct frame
*f
)
3706 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3708 result
->kind
= MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT
;
3709 result
->code
= event
->button
- Button1
;
3710 result
->timestamp
= event
->time
;
3711 result
->modifiers
= (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
3713 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
3717 XSETINT (result
->x
, event
->x
);
3718 XSETINT (result
->y
, event
->y
);
3719 XSETFRAME (result
->frame_or_window
, f
);
3725 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3726 The input handler calls this.
3728 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3729 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3730 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3731 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3733 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event
;
3734 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame
;
3737 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame
, XMotionEvent
*event
)
3739 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
3740 last_mouse_motion_event
= *event
;
3741 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
, frame
);
3743 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame
))
3746 if (event
->window
!= FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame
))
3748 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3749 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3750 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, -1, -1);
3751 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
3756 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3757 if (frame
!= last_mouse_glyph_frame
3758 || event
->x
< last_mouse_glyph
.x
3759 || event
->x
>= last_mouse_glyph
.x
+ last_mouse_glyph
.width
3760 || event
->y
< last_mouse_glyph
.y
3761 || event
->y
>= last_mouse_glyph
.y
+ last_mouse_glyph
.height
)
3763 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3764 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3765 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
);
3766 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3767 remember_mouse_glyph (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3768 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= frame
;
3776 /************************************************************************
3778 ************************************************************************/
3781 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3783 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame
)
3784 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
)))
3785 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
),
3786 last_mouse_motion_event
.x
,
3787 last_mouse_motion_event
.y
);
3792 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3793 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3795 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3796 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3797 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3798 position on the scroll bar.
3800 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3801 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3804 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3805 was at this position.
3807 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3809 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3813 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR
*fp
, int insist
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
, enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
, Lisp_Object
*y
, long unsigned int *time
)
3819 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar
) && insist
== 0)
3820 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, time
);
3826 Window dummy_window
;
3829 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
3831 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3832 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3833 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
3834 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
))
3835 XFRAME (frame
)->mouse_moved
= 0;
3837 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3839 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3840 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3841 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)),
3843 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3846 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3847 a different screen. */
3850 /* The position on that root window. */
3853 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3856 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3858 (unsigned int *) &dummy
);
3860 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3861 containing the pointer. */
3865 int parent_x
= 0, parent_y
= 0;
3869 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3870 structure is changing at the same time this function
3871 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3873 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
));
3875 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
)->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
3876 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
3878 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3879 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3880 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3882 /* From-window, to-window. */
3883 root
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame
),
3885 /* From-position, to-position. */
3886 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3890 f1
= last_mouse_frame
;
3896 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3898 /* From-window, to-window. */
3901 /* From-position, to-position. */
3902 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3907 if (child
== None
|| child
== win
)
3910 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3911 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3912 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3913 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3914 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
))
3922 /* Now we know that:
3923 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3924 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3925 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3926 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3927 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3928 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3929 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3930 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3931 never use them in that case.) */
3934 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3935 want the edit window. */
3936 f1
= x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3938 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3939 f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3942 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3943 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3946 && f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
3947 && win
== XtWindow (f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
))
3949 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3952 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)))
3955 x_uncatch_errors ();
3957 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3960 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
3962 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
), win
);
3966 f1
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
3972 if (f1
== 0 && insist
> 0)
3973 f1
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
3977 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3978 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3979 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3980 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3981 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3982 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3983 the frame are divided into. */
3985 remember_mouse_glyph (f1
, win_x
, win_y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3986 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= f1
;
3991 XSETINT (*x
, win_x
);
3992 XSETINT (*y
, win_y
);
3993 *time
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
4003 /***********************************************************************
4005 ***********************************************************************/
4007 /* Scroll bar support. */
4009 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4011 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4014 static struct scroll_bar
*
4015 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*display
, Window window_id
)
4019 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4020 window_id
= (Window
) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display
, window_id
);
4021 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4023 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
4025 Lisp_Object frame
, bar
, condemned
;
4027 frame
= XCAR (tail
);
4028 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4029 if (! FRAMEP (frame
))
4032 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4035 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4037 condemned
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4038 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4039 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4040 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4041 ! NILP (bar
) || (bar
= condemned
,
4044 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
4045 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
== window_id
&&
4046 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == display
)
4047 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
4054 #if defined USE_LUCID
4056 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4057 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4060 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window
)
4064 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
4066 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail
))))
4068 Lisp_Object frame
= XCAR (tail
);
4069 Widget menu_bar
= XFRAME (frame
)->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
;
4071 if (menu_bar
&& xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar
, window
))
4079 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4082 /************************************************************************
4084 ************************************************************************/
4086 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4088 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent
*, struct input_event
*);
4089 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object
, int, int, int);
4090 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*,
4091 struct scroll_bar
*);
4092 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*,
4096 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4097 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4099 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled
;
4101 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4103 static int last_scroll_bar_part
;
4105 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4106 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4109 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4111 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id
;
4113 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll
;
4115 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4116 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4117 to avoid jerkyness. */
4119 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top
;
4121 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4122 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4123 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4124 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4127 xt_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4128 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4131 const char *end_action
;
4134 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4135 end_action
= "Release";
4136 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4137 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4138 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4139 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4142 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4143 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4147 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4148 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4149 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4151 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
))
4153 XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
= Qnil
;
4154 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4155 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w
);
4157 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4158 last_scroll_bar_part
= -1;
4160 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4161 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 0;
4164 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4166 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4167 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4169 static struct window
**scroll_bar_windows
;
4170 static int scroll_bar_windows_size
;
4173 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4174 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4175 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4176 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4179 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window
, int part
, int portion
, int whole
)
4182 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) &event
;
4183 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (window
);
4184 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4189 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4190 ev
->type
= ClientMessage
;
4191 ev
->message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Scrollbar
;
4192 ev
->display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
4193 ev
->window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
4196 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4197 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4198 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4199 into that array in the event. */
4200 for (i
= 0; i
< scroll_bar_windows_size
; ++i
)
4201 if (scroll_bar_windows
[i
] == NULL
)
4204 if (i
== scroll_bar_windows_size
)
4206 int new_size
= max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size
);
4207 size_t nbytes
= new_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4208 size_t old_nbytes
= scroll_bar_windows_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4210 scroll_bar_windows
= (struct window
**) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows
,
4212 memset (&scroll_bar_windows
[i
], 0, nbytes
- old_nbytes
);
4213 scroll_bar_windows_size
= new_size
;
4216 scroll_bar_windows
[i
] = w
;
4217 ev
->data
.l
[0] = (long) i
;
4218 ev
->data
.l
[1] = (long) part
;
4219 ev
->data
.l
[2] = (long) 0;
4220 ev
->data
.l
[3] = (long) portion
;
4221 ev
->data
.l
[4] = (long) whole
;
4223 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4224 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 1;
4225 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4226 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4229 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4230 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4231 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4232 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), False
, 0, &event
);
4237 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4241 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*ievent
)
4243 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) event
;
4248 w
= scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]];
4249 scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]] = NULL
;
4251 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4252 f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4254 ievent
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4255 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4258 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4260 ievent
->timestamp
= XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
4262 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4263 ievent
->code
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4264 ievent
->x
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4265 ievent
->y
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4266 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4272 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4274 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4277 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4278 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4279 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4282 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4284 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4285 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*cs
= (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*) call_data
;
4286 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4290 case XmCR_DECREMENT
:
4291 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4292 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4295 case XmCR_INCREMENT
:
4296 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4297 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4300 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT
:
4301 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4302 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4305 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT
:
4306 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4307 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4311 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4312 part
= scroll_bar_to_top
;
4315 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM
:
4316 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4317 part
= scroll_bar_to_bottom
;
4324 /* Get the slider size. */
4326 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XmNsliderSize
, &slider_size
, NULL
);
4329 whole
= XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
;
4330 portion
= min (cs
->value
, whole
);
4331 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4332 bar
->dragging
= make_number (cs
->value
);
4336 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4342 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4343 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4344 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4348 #elif defined USE_GTK
4350 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4351 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4354 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange
*range
,
4355 GtkScrollType scroll
,
4359 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) user_data
;
4361 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4362 GtkAdjustment
*adj
= GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range
));
4363 FRAME_PTR f
= (FRAME_PTR
) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range
), XG_FRAME_DATA
);
4365 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar
) return FALSE
;
4366 position
= gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj
);
4371 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP
:
4372 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4373 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
!= 0
4374 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
< (1 << 4))
4376 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4377 whole
= gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4378 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
);
4379 portion
= min ((int)position
, whole
);
4380 bar
->dragging
= make_number ((int)portion
);
4383 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD
:
4384 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4385 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4387 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD
:
4388 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4389 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4391 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD
:
4392 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4393 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4395 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD
:
4396 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4397 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4403 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4404 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4405 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4411 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4414 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget
*widget
,
4415 GdkEventButton
*event
,
4418 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) user_data
;
4419 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4420 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4422 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4423 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4424 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4431 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4433 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4434 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4435 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4439 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4441 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4442 float top
= *(float *) call_data
;
4444 int whole
, portion
, height
;
4447 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4449 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4453 portion
= shown
< 1 ? top
* whole
: 0;
4455 if (shown
< 1 && (eabs (top
+ shown
- 1) < 1.0/height
))
4456 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4457 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4458 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4459 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4461 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4463 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4465 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4466 bar
->dragging
= make_number (portion
);
4467 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4468 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4472 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4473 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4474 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4475 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4476 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4477 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4478 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4481 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4483 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4484 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4485 int position
= (long) call_data
;
4489 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4491 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4494 if (eabs (position
) >= height
)
4495 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4497 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4498 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4499 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, height
/ 20))
4500 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4502 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4504 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4505 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4506 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4507 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, height
);
4510 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4512 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4514 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4515 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4519 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4521 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4524 xg_create_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4525 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4530 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4533 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4539 char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4540 unsigned long pixel
;
4545 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4546 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4547 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
4548 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
4549 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmVERTICAL
); ++ac
;
4550 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM
), ++ac
;
4551 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4552 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4554 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4557 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
4561 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4564 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
4568 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
4569 scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
4571 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4572 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4574 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4576 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4578 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4580 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4582 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4584 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4587 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4588 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4590 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4591 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4592 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
4593 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
4595 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4597 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4598 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4599 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4600 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4601 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4602 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientVertical
); ++ac
;
4603 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4604 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4606 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4609 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
4613 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4616 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
4620 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4622 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4623 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4625 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4628 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4629 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4630 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
4632 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4635 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4637 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4640 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4641 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4642 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
4644 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4648 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4649 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4650 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
4651 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4652 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4653 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4654 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4657 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
4658 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
4662 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4663 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4664 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4666 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4668 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
4671 /* Specify the colors. */
4672 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
4675 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4678 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
4681 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4687 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
4688 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
4692 char *val
= initial
;
4693 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
4694 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4695 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
4697 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
4698 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
4699 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4700 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
4701 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4702 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
4706 /* Define callbacks. */
4707 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
4708 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
4711 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4712 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4714 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4716 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4717 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4718 if (action_hook_id
== 0)
4719 action_hook_id
= XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_action_hook
, 0);
4721 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4722 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
4723 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
4724 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
4728 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4731 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4732 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4736 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
4738 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
4741 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4743 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
4746 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4747 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4754 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4755 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4756 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4757 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4758 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4759 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4760 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4761 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4762 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4763 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4764 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4765 portion
= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)) * 30;
4766 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4767 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4774 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4775 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4778 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4782 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4783 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4785 size
= shown
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4786 size
= min (size
, XM_SB_MAX
);
4787 size
= max (size
, 1);
4789 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4790 value
= top
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4791 value
= min (value
, XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
4793 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
4795 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4801 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4802 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4806 float old_top
, old_shown
;
4808 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
4809 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
4810 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
4814 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4815 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
) || last_scroll_bar_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
4816 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
4819 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4820 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0 / height
), shown
));
4822 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4823 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4824 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4825 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
4827 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4828 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4831 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4832 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
4833 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
4835 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4839 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4843 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4845 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4849 /************************************************************************
4850 Scroll bars, general
4851 ************************************************************************/
4853 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4854 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4855 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4858 static struct scroll_bar
*
4859 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window
*w
, int top
, int left
, int width
, int height
)
4861 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4862 struct scroll_bar
*bar
4863 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar
, x_window
, PVEC_OTHER
);
4867 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4868 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
4869 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4871 XSetWindowAttributes a
;
4875 a
.background_pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4876 if (a
.background_pixel
== -1)
4877 a
.background_pixel
= FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
4879 a
.event_mask
= (ButtonPressMask
| ButtonReleaseMask
4880 | ButtonMotionMask
| PointerMotionHintMask
4882 a
.cursor
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
;
4884 mask
= (CWBackPixel
| CWEventMask
| CWCursor
);
4886 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4887 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4888 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4889 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
4890 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4892 window_box_height (w
), False
);
4894 window
= XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4895 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4896 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4898 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4900 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4907 bar
->x_window
= window
;
4909 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4911 XSETWINDOW (bar
->window
, w
);
4915 bar
->height
= height
;
4918 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4919 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= 0;
4921 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4922 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
4924 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), bar
);
4925 if (!NILP (bar
->next
))
4926 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
4928 /* Map the window/widget. */
4929 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4932 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
4935 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4936 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4938 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4939 Widget scroll_bar
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4940 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar
,
4941 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4943 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4944 max (height
, 1), 0);
4945 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar
);
4946 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4948 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4949 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
4950 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4957 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4959 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4961 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4962 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4963 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4966 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4967 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4968 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4969 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4970 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4973 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int start
, int end
, int rebuild
)
4975 int dragging
= ! NILP (bar
->dragging
);
4976 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
4977 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4978 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
4980 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4982 && start
== bar
->start
4989 int inside_width
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f
, bar
->width
);
4990 int inside_height
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
4991 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
4993 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4994 the distance between start and end. */
4996 int length
= end
- start
;
5000 else if (start
> top_range
)
5002 end
= start
+ length
;
5006 else if (end
> top_range
&& ! dragging
)
5010 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5014 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5015 if (end
> top_range
)
5018 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5019 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5020 that many pixels tall. */
5021 end
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
;
5023 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5024 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5026 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5027 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5028 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5029 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
,
5030 inside_width
, start
,
5033 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5034 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5035 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5036 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5038 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5039 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5040 /* x, y, width, height */
5041 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5042 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ start
,
5043 inside_width
, end
- start
);
5045 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5046 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5047 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5048 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5050 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5051 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5052 if (end
< inside_height
)
5053 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5054 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5055 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5056 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ end
,
5057 inside_width
, inside_height
- end
,
5065 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5067 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5071 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5073 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5076 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5078 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f
, bar
->x_window
);
5079 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5080 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
));
5081 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5083 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5086 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5087 XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->vertical_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5093 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5094 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5095 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5099 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5101 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5102 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5103 int top
, height
, left
, sb_left
, width
, sb_width
;
5104 int window_y
, window_height
;
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 int fringe_extended_p
;
5109 /* Get window dimensions. */
5110 window_box (w
, -1, 0, &window_y
, 0, &window_height
);
5112 width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5113 height
= window_height
;
5115 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5116 left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
5118 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5119 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5120 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
) > 0)
5121 sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
5125 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5126 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5127 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5128 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
) ? width
- sb_width
: 0);
5130 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
) ? 0 : width
- sb_width
);
5132 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5133 sb_left
= left
+ width
- sb_width
;
5138 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5139 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5140 fringe_extended_p
= (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
5141 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w
)
5142 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w
)
5143 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w
) == 0));
5145 fringe_extended_p
= (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
5146 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w
)
5147 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w
)
5148 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w
) == 0));
5151 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5152 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5154 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5157 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5158 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5159 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5160 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
, False
);
5163 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5164 left
, top
, width
, height
, False
);
5168 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, sb_left
, sb_width
, height
);
5172 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5173 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5175 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5179 if (sb_left
!= bar
->left
)
5181 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5183 if (sb_width
!= bar
->width
)
5185 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5188 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5190 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5191 if (mask
|| bar
->fringe_extended_p
!= fringe_extended_p
)
5193 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5194 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5195 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5197 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5198 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5199 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
, False
);
5201 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5202 left
, top
, width
, height
, False
);
5205 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
5208 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5209 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
*2,
5211 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5212 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5213 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5215 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
5216 max (height
, 1), 0);
5217 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5219 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5221 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5222 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5223 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
)
5225 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5226 left
, top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5228 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5229 left
+ width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5230 top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5234 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5235 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5236 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5239 int area_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5240 int rest
= area_width
- sb_width
;
5241 if (rest
> 0 && height
> 0)
5243 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5244 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5245 left
+ area_width
- rest
, top
,
5246 rest
, height
, False
);
5248 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5249 left
, top
, rest
, height
, False
);
5253 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5258 wc
.x
= sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5260 wc
.width
= sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2;
5262 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5266 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5268 /* Remember new settings. */
5269 bar
->left
= sb_left
;
5271 bar
->width
= sb_width
;
5272 bar
->height
= height
;
5277 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5278 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= fringe_extended_p
;
5280 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5281 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5282 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5284 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5286 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, height
);
5289 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, top_range
, 0);
5292 int start
= ((double) position
* top_range
) / whole
;
5293 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * top_range
) / whole
;
5294 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, 0);
5297 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5299 XSETVECTOR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5303 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5304 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5305 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5306 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5307 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5308 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5309 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5311 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5312 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5313 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5316 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame
)
5318 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5319 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5322 bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5323 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
;
5324 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5325 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->prev
= Qnil
;
5326 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5327 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
))->prev
= bar
;
5328 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
) = bar
;
5333 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5334 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5337 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window
*window
)
5339 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5342 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5343 if (NILP (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5346 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5348 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5349 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window
));
5350 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
5352 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5354 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5355 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5357 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
5358 window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5359 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
) = bar
->next
;
5361 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5362 one or the other! */
5366 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
5368 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5369 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
5371 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5373 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), bar
);
5374 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5375 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
5378 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5379 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5382 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f
)
5384 Lisp_Object bar
, next
;
5386 bar
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5388 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5389 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5390 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
) = Qnil
;
5392 for (; ! NILP (bar
); bar
= next
)
5394 struct scroll_bar
*b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
5396 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
5399 b
->next
= b
->prev
= Qnil
;
5402 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5403 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5407 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5408 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5409 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5411 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5415 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
)
5417 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5418 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5419 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
5420 int width_trim
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5424 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, bar
->start
, bar
->end
, 1);
5426 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5427 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5428 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5429 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5431 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5432 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5434 /* x, y, width, height */
5436 bar
->width
- 1 - width_trim
- width_trim
,
5439 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5440 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5441 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5442 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5447 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5449 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5450 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5452 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5457 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*emacs_event
)
5459 if (! WINDOWP (bar
->window
))
5462 emacs_event
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
5463 emacs_event
->code
= event
->xbutton
.button
- Button1
;
5464 emacs_event
->modifiers
5465 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5466 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)))),
5467 event
->xbutton
.state
)
5468 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5471 emacs_event
->frame_or_window
= bar
->window
;
5472 emacs_event
->arg
= Qnil
;
5473 emacs_event
->timestamp
= event
->xbutton
.time
;
5476 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5477 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5480 if (y
> top_range
) y
= top_range
;
5483 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5484 else if (y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5485 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5487 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5489 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5490 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5491 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5492 && ! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5494 int new_start
= y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5495 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5497 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5498 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
5502 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
5503 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, top_range
);
5507 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5509 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5511 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5515 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
)
5517 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->frame
);
5519 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->xmotion
.time
;
5522 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5524 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5525 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5527 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5528 int new_start
= event
->xmotion
.y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5530 if (new_start
!= bar
->start
)
5532 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5534 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5539 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5541 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5542 on the scroll bar. */
5545 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR
*fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
, enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
, Lisp_Object
*y
, long unsigned int *time
)
5547 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
5548 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5549 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5551 Window dummy_window
;
5553 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
5557 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5559 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5561 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5562 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
5563 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
5565 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5568 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5574 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5576 win_y
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5578 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5579 win_y
-= XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5583 if (win_y
> top_range
)
5587 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
5589 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5590 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5591 else if (win_y
< bar
->start
)
5592 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5593 else if (win_y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5594 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5596 *part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5598 XSETINT (*x
, win_y
);
5599 XSETINT (*y
, top_range
);
5602 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5605 *time
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
5611 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5612 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5613 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5617 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f
)
5619 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5622 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5623 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5624 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5625 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
5626 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); VECTORP (bar
);
5627 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
5628 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5629 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
,
5631 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5635 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5637 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5638 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5639 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5640 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5642 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5643 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5645 static XComposeStatus compose_status
;
5647 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5648 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5650 static int temp_index
;
5651 static short temp_buffer
[100];
5653 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5654 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5656 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5658 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5659 on a particular display. */
5661 struct x_display_info
*XTread_socket_fake_io_error
;
5663 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5664 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5665 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5666 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5668 static struct x_display_info
*next_noop_dpyinfo
;
5670 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5673 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5674 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5675 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5676 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5677 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5678 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5689 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5690 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5691 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5693 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5695 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5699 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
)
5701 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5702 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5703 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5706 struct frame
*f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5707 event
->xclient
.window
);
5709 return XFilterEvent (event
, f1
? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1
) : None
);
5714 static int current_count
;
5715 static int current_finish
;
5716 static struct input_event
*current_hold_quit
;
5718 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5719 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5720 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5721 static GdkFilterReturn
5722 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent
*gxev
, GdkEvent
*ev
, gpointer data
)
5724 XEvent
*xev
= (XEvent
*) gxev
;
5727 if (current_count
>= 0)
5729 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
5731 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (xev
->xany
.display
);
5734 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5735 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5736 so we do it here. */
5737 if ((xev
->type
== KeyPress
|| xev
->type
== KeyRelease
)
5739 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, xev
))
5742 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5747 current_finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5750 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, xev
, ¤t_finish
,
5754 current_finish
= x_dispatch_event (xev
, xev
->xany
.display
);
5758 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
|| current_finish
== X_EVENT_DROP
)
5759 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5761 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE
;
5763 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5766 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time time
,
5767 enum xembed_message message
,
5768 long detail
, long data1
, long data2
);
5770 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5772 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5773 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5774 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5776 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5779 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*eventp
, int *finish
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
5782 struct input_event ie
;
5783 struct selection_input_event sie
;
5788 struct frame
*f
= NULL
;
5789 struct coding_system coding
;
5790 XEvent event
= *eventp
;
5791 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
5793 *finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5795 EVENT_INIT (inev
.ie
);
5796 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
;
5799 if (pending_event_wait
.eventtype
== event
.type
)
5800 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5806 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5807 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
5808 && event
.xclient
.format
== 32)
5810 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5811 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
5813 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5814 could be the shell widget window
5815 if the frame has no title bar. */
5816 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5818 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5819 if (f
&& FRAME_XIC (f
))
5820 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f
));
5822 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5823 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5824 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5825 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5826 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5829 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5830 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5831 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5832 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5835 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5836 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5837 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5840 Display
*d
= event
.xclient
.display
;
5841 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5842 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5844 XSetInputFocus (d
, event
.xclient
.window
,
5845 /* The ICCCM says this is
5846 the only valid choice. */
5848 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1]);
5849 /* This is needed to detect the error
5850 if there is an error. */
5852 x_uncatch_errors ();
5854 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5859 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5860 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
5862 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5863 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5864 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5865 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5866 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5867 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5868 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5869 session manager and one for this. */
5871 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5874 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5875 event
.xclient
.window
);
5876 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5877 for a single Emacs process. */
5878 if (f
== SELECTED_FRAME ())
5879 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5880 event
.xclient
.window
,
5881 initial_argv
, initial_argc
);
5883 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5884 event
.xclient
.window
,
5890 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5891 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
5893 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5894 event
.xclient
.window
);
5896 goto OTHER
; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5898 inev
.ie
.kind
= DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT
;
5899 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
5906 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5907 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
5912 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5913 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
5916 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5918 new_x
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[0];
5919 new_y
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[1];
5923 f
->left_pos
= new_x
;
5930 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5931 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
)
5933 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5935 _XEditResCheckMessages (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, NULL
,
5939 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5941 if ((event
.xclient
.message_type
5942 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
)
5943 || (event
.xclient
.message_type
5944 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
))
5946 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5947 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5948 currently never do because we are interested in
5949 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5950 Pixmap pixmap
= (Pixmap
) event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5951 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5954 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap
, f
);
5955 expose_frame (f
, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5959 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5960 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5961 we construct an input_event. */
5962 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5963 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
)
5965 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event
, &inev
.ie
);
5966 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
5969 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5971 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5972 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5973 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
5975 enum xembed_message msg
= event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5976 if (msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
|| msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
)
5977 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
5979 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
5983 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
5985 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5988 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f
, &event
.xclient
, dpyinfo
, &inev
.ie
))
5989 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
5993 case SelectionNotify
:
5994 last_user_time
= event
.xselection
.time
;
5995 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5996 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselection
.requestor
))
5998 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5999 x_handle_selection_notify (&event
.xselection
);
6002 case SelectionClear
: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6003 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionclear
.time
;
6004 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6005 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionclear
.window
))
6007 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6009 XSelectionClearEvent
*eventp
= (XSelectionClearEvent
*) &event
;
6011 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT
;
6012 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6013 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6014 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6015 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= Qnil
;
6019 case SelectionRequest
: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6020 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionrequest
.time
;
6021 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6022 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionrequest
.owner
))
6024 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6026 XSelectionRequestEvent
*eventp
6027 = (XSelectionRequestEvent
*) &event
;
6029 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT
;
6030 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6031 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->requestor
;
6032 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6033 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->target
;
6034 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->property
;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6036 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= Qnil
;
6040 case PropertyNotify
:
6041 last_user_time
= event
.xproperty
.time
;
6042 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xproperty
.window
);
6043 if (f
&& event
.xproperty
.atom
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
)
6044 x_handle_net_wm_state (f
, &event
.xproperty
);
6046 x_handle_property_notify (&event
.xproperty
);
6047 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6050 case ReparentNotify
:
6051 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xreparent
.window
);
6055 f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
= event
.xreparent
.parent
;
6056 x_real_positions (f
, &x
, &y
);
6060 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6061 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
6062 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->net_supported_window
= 0;
6067 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xexpose
.window
);
6071 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6072 x_clear_area (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6073 event
.xexpose
.window
,
6074 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6075 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
,
6078 if (f
->async_visible
== 0)
6080 f
->async_visible
= 1;
6081 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
6082 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6083 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6087 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6088 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
);
6092 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6093 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6095 #if defined USE_LUCID
6096 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6097 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6098 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6101 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event
.xexpose
.window
);
6103 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget
);
6105 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6107 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6108 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6110 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6111 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6112 event
.xexpose
.window
);
6115 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, &event
);
6116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6119 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6120 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6124 case GraphicsExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6125 source area was obscured or not
6127 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.drawable
);
6131 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.x
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.y
,
6132 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.width
,
6133 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.height
);
6135 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6138 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6141 case NoExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6142 source area was completely
6147 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6148 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6151 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6154 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xunmap
.window
);
6155 if (f
) /* F may no longer exist if
6156 the frame was deleted. */
6158 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6159 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6160 display that won't ever be seen. */
6161 f
->async_visible
= 0;
6162 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6163 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6164 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6165 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6166 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6167 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6168 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6170 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
6172 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6173 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6179 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6180 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6181 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6184 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6185 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6186 frame is visible. */
6187 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmap
.window
);
6190 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6191 the frame's display structures.
6192 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6193 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6194 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6195 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6196 if (! f
->async_iconified
)
6197 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6199 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6200 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6201 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
)
6202 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
6204 f
->async_visible
= 1;
6205 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
6206 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6210 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6211 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6213 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list
)
6214 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
6215 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6216 to update the frame titles
6217 in case this is the second frame. */
6218 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6221 xg_frame_resized (f
, -1, -1);
6228 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6229 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6231 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6232 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6233 if (popup_activated ())
6237 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xkey
.window
);
6239 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6240 mouse highlighting. */
6241 if (!hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
&& INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight
)
6243 || !EQ (f
->tool_bar_window
, hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
)))
6245 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6246 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 1;
6249 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6252 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6253 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6254 Widget widget
= XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo
->display
,
6256 if (widget
&& XmIsScrollBar (widget
))
6258 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
6259 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, XtWindow (widget
));
6262 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6266 KeySym keysym
, orig_keysym
;
6267 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6268 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6271 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6272 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6273 status_return even if the input is too long to
6274 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6275 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6276 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6277 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6278 unsigned char copy_buffer
[513];
6279 unsigned char *copy_bufptr
= copy_buffer
;
6280 int copy_bufsiz
= sizeof (copy_buffer
);
6282 Lisp_Object coding_system
= Qlatin_1
;
6286 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6287 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6288 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6290 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6294 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
6295 extra_keyboard_modifiers
);
6296 modifiers
= event
.xkey
.state
;
6298 /* This will have to go some day... */
6300 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6301 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6302 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~ControlMask
;
6303 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~(dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
6304 | dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
6305 | dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
6306 | dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
);
6308 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6309 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6310 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6311 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6312 not it is combined with Meta. */
6313 if (modifiers
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
6314 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6319 Status status_return
;
6321 coding_system
= Vlocale_coding_system
;
6322 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6323 &event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6324 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6326 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
6328 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
6329 copy_bufptr
= (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
6330 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6331 &event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6332 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6335 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6336 if (status_return
== XLookupNone
)
6338 else if (status_return
== XLookupChars
)
6343 else if (status_return
!= XLookupKeySym
6344 && status_return
!= XLookupBoth
)
6348 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6349 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6352 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, copy_bufptr
,
6353 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6357 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6358 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6359 if (compose_status
.chars_matched
> 0 && nbytes
== 0)
6362 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6363 orig_keysym
= keysym
;
6365 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6366 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6368 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
), modifiers
);
6369 inev
.ie
.timestamp
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6371 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6372 translations to characters. */
6373 if (keysym
>= 32 && keysym
< 128)
6374 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6376 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6377 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6381 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6382 if (keysym
>= 0x01000000 && keysym
<= 0x0110FFFF)
6384 if (keysym
< 0x01000080)
6385 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6387 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6388 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
& 0xFFFFFF;
6392 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6393 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table
)
6394 && (NATNUMP (c
= Fgethash (make_number (keysym
),
6398 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c
))
6399 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6400 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6401 inev
.ie
.code
= XFASTINT (c
);
6405 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6406 if (((keysym
>= XK_BackSpace
&& keysym
<= XK_Escape
)
6407 || keysym
== XK_Delete
6408 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6409 || (keysym
>= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6410 && keysym
<= XK_ISO_Enter
)
6412 || IsCursorKey (keysym
) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6413 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6415 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6416 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6417 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6418 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6419 || ((unsigned) (keysym
) >= XK_Select
6420 && (unsigned)(keysym
) < XK_KP_Space
)
6422 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6423 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_circumflex
6425 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6426 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_grave
6428 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6429 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_tilde
6431 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6432 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_diaeresis
6434 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6435 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_macron
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6438 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_degree
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6441 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_acute
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6444 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_cedilla
6446 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6447 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_breve
6449 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6450 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_ogonek
6452 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6453 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_caron
6455 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6456 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_doubleacute
6458 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6459 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_abovedot
6461 || IsKeypadKey (keysym
) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6462 || IsFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6463 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6464 || (orig_keysym
& (1 << 28))
6465 || (keysym
!= NoSymbol
&& nbytes
== 0))
6466 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym
)
6467 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6468 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6469 don't have real modifiers but
6470 should be treated similarly to
6471 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6472 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6473 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym
)
6475 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym
)
6476 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
)
6480 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym
);
6481 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6483 inev
.ie
.kind
= NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6484 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6488 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6493 for (i
= 0, nchars
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
++)
6495 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr
[i
]))
6497 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr
[i
]);
6500 if (nchars
< nbytes
)
6502 /* Decode the input data. */
6505 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6506 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6507 we used just above and the locale. */
6508 setup_coding_system (coding_system
, &coding
);
6509 coding
.src_multibyte
= 0;
6510 coding
.dst_multibyte
= 1;
6511 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6512 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6513 gives us composition information. */
6514 coding
.common_flags
&= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK
;
6516 require
= MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
* nbytes
;
6517 coding
.destination
= alloca (require
);
6518 coding
.dst_bytes
= require
;
6519 coding
.mode
|= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK
;
6520 decode_coding_c_string (&coding
, copy_bufptr
, nbytes
, Qnil
);
6521 nbytes
= coding
.produced
;
6522 nchars
= coding
.produced_char
;
6523 copy_bufptr
= coding
.destination
;
6526 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6527 character events. */
6528 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
+= len
)
6530 if (nchars
== nbytes
)
6531 c
= copy_bufptr
[i
], len
= 1;
6533 c
= STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr
+ i
, len
);
6534 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c
)
6535 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6536 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6538 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6543 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
; /* Already stored above. */
6545 if (keysym
== NoSymbol
)
6551 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6552 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6560 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6562 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6563 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6571 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6572 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6574 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6576 if (f
&& x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
)
6577 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= event
.xmotion
.time
+ 200;
6579 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6580 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6581 if (f
&& !f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_p
)
6582 note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
);
6584 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6585 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6586 if (!f
&& last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6587 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6592 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6596 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6597 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6599 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6602 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
6604 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6605 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6606 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6607 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
6610 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6611 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6612 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6613 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6614 if (any_help_event_p
)
6618 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6619 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6620 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6625 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6630 last_user_time
= event
.xmotion
.time
;
6631 previous_help_echo_string
= help_echo_string
;
6632 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6634 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
6635 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6636 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6638 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmotion
.window
);
6640 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
)
6642 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
6643 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6647 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, &event
))
6653 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6654 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6655 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window
) && !popup_activated ())
6659 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
,
6660 event
.xmotion
.x
, event
.xmotion
.y
,
6663 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6664 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6665 will be selected only when it is active. */
6666 if (WINDOWP (window
)
6667 && !EQ (window
, last_window
)
6668 && !EQ (window
, selected_window
)
6669 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6670 create event iff we don't leave the
6672 && (focus_follows_mouse
6673 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window
)->frame
,
6674 XWINDOW (selected_window
)->frame
))))
6676 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT
;
6677 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= window
;
6682 if (!note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
))
6683 help_echo_string
= previous_help_echo_string
;
6687 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6688 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6689 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xmotion
.display
,
6690 event
.xmotion
.window
);
6693 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, &event
);
6694 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6696 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6697 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6698 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6701 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6702 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6703 if (!NILP (help_echo_string
)
6704 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string
))
6709 case ConfigureNotify
:
6710 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
);
6713 && (f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
))
6714 && event
.xconfigure
.window
== FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
6716 xg_frame_resized (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
,
6717 event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6723 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6725 int rows
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6726 int columns
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
);
6728 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6729 is called by the code that handles resizing
6730 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6732 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6733 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6734 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6735 if (columns
!= FRAME_COLS (f
)
6736 || rows
!= FRAME_LINES (f
)
6737 || event
.xconfigure
.width
!= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6738 || event
.xconfigure
.height
!= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
))
6740 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, columns
, 0, 1, 0);
6741 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6742 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
6745 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.width
;
6746 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.height
;
6747 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6751 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6752 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6753 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)
6754 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)))
6757 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
6761 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
))
6762 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
6771 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6772 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6775 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6776 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
6777 last_user_time
= event
.xbutton
.time
;
6779 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
6781 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6782 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6784 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xbutton
.window
);
6787 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, &event
))
6792 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6793 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
6794 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
)))
6797 int x
= event
.xbutton
.x
;
6798 int y
= event
.xbutton
.y
;
6800 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
, x
, y
, 0, 1);
6801 tool_bar_p
= EQ (window
, f
->tool_bar_window
);
6803 if (tool_bar_p
&& event
.xbutton
.button
< 4)
6805 handle_tool_bar_click (f
, x
, y
,
6806 event
.xbutton
.type
== ButtonPress
,
6807 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
,
6808 event
.xbutton
.state
));
6813 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6814 if (! popup_activated ())
6817 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
6819 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
6820 && (int)(event
.xbutton
.time
- ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
) > 0)
6822 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6823 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6825 if (event
.type
== ButtonRelease
)
6826 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6829 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6831 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
6832 xembed_send_message (f
, event
.xbutton
.time
,
6833 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
6837 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6838 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xbutton
.display
,
6839 event
.xbutton
.window
);
6841 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6842 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6844 if (bar
&& event
.xbutton
.state
& ControlMask
)
6846 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6847 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6849 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6851 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6852 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6855 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6857 dpyinfo
->grabbed
|= (1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6858 last_mouse_frame
= f
;
6861 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
6864 dpyinfo
->grabbed
&= ~(1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6866 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6867 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6868 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6872 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6873 f
= x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6874 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6875 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6876 Instead, save it away
6877 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6878 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6879 if (! popup_activated ()
6881 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6882 && event
.xbutton
.button
< 3
6884 && f
&& event
.type
== ButtonPress
6885 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6886 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6887 && event
.xbutton
.x
>= 0
6888 && event
.xbutton
.x
< FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6889 && event
.xbutton
.y
>= 0
6890 && event
.xbutton
.y
< f
->output_data
.x
->menubar_height
6891 && event
.xbutton
.same_screen
)
6893 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT
;
6894 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame
, f
);
6895 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6897 else if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6899 last_mouse_press_frame
= Qnil
;
6904 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6908 case CirculateNotify
:
6911 case CirculateRequest
:
6914 case VisibilityNotify
:
6918 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6920 switch (event
.xmapping
.request
)
6922 case MappingModifier
:
6923 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
6924 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6925 case MappingKeyboard
:
6926 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event
.xmapping
);
6931 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6936 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6938 if (*finish
!= X_EVENT_DROP
)
6939 XtDispatchEvent (&event
);
6941 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6946 if (inev
.ie
.kind
!= NO_EVENT
)
6948 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6953 && !(hold_quit
&& hold_quit
->kind
!= NO_EVENT
))
6958 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
6964 any_help_event_p
= 1;
6965 gen_help_event (help_echo_string
, frame
, help_echo_window
,
6966 help_echo_object
, help_echo_pos
);
6970 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6971 gen_help_event (Qnil
, frame
, Qnil
, Qnil
, 0);
6981 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6982 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6983 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6985 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6987 x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*event
, Display
*display
)
6989 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
6990 int finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
6992 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (display
);
6995 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, event
, &finish
, 0);
7001 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7002 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7003 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7005 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7006 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7007 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7010 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7013 XTread_socket (struct terminal
*terminal
, int expected
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
7017 int event_found
= 0;
7019 if (interrupt_input_blocked
)
7021 interrupt_input_pending
= 1;
7023 pending_signals
= 1;
7028 interrupt_input_pending
= 0;
7030 pending_signals
= pending_atimers
;
7034 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7035 input_signal_count
++;
7040 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7041 if (terminal
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7043 struct input_event inev
;
7045 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7046 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7047 if (x_session_check_input (&inev
))
7049 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
, hold_quit
);
7056 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7057 if (terminal
->display_info
.x
== XTread_socket_fake_io_error
)
7059 XTread_socket_fake_io_error
= 0;
7060 x_io_error_quitter (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
);
7064 while (XPending (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
))
7068 XNextEvent (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
, &event
);
7071 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7072 if (x_filter_event (terminal
->display_info
.x
, &event
))
7077 count
+= handle_one_xevent (terminal
->display_info
.x
,
7078 &event
, &finish
, hold_quit
);
7080 if (finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7086 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7087 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7088 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7089 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7091 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7092 from all displays. */
7094 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7096 current_count
= count
;
7097 current_hold_quit
= hold_quit
;
7099 gtk_main_iteration ();
7101 count
= current_count
;
7103 current_hold_quit
= 0;
7105 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7108 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7112 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7113 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7116 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7117 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7118 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7120 if (x_noop_count
>= 100)
7124 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== 0)
7125 next_noop_dpyinfo
= x_display_list
;
7127 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo
->display
);
7129 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7130 next_noop_dpyinfo
= next_noop_dpyinfo
->next
;
7134 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7136 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7137 if (pending_autoraise_frame
)
7139 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame
);
7140 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
7152 /***********************************************************************
7154 ***********************************************************************/
7156 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7157 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7159 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7160 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7161 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7164 x_clip_to_row (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int area
, GC gc
)
7166 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7167 XRectangle clip_rect
;
7168 int window_x
, window_y
, window_width
;
7170 window_box (w
, area
, &window_x
, &window_y
, &window_width
, 0);
7172 clip_rect
.x
= window_x
;
7173 clip_rect
.y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, row
->y
));
7174 clip_rect
.y
= max (clip_rect
.y
, window_y
);
7175 clip_rect
.width
= window_width
;
7176 clip_rect
.height
= row
->visible_height
;
7178 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
, 0, 0, &clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
7182 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7185 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
)
7187 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7188 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
7189 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7192 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7195 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7196 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7197 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7198 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7201 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7202 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &x
, &y
, &h
);
7203 wd
= w
->phys_cursor_width
;
7205 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7206 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7207 xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7208 if (dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
)
7209 XChangeGC (dpy
, dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7211 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7212 GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7213 gc
= dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7215 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7216 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7217 XDrawRectangle (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
, x
, y
, wd
, h
- 1);
7218 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7222 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7224 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7225 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7226 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7230 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int width
, enum text_cursor_kinds kind
)
7232 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
7233 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7235 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7236 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7238 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7239 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7242 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7243 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7244 the bar might not be in the window. */
7245 if (cursor_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
)
7247 struct glyph_row
*row
;
7248 row
= MATRIX_ROW (w
->current_matrix
, w
->phys_cursor
.vpos
);
7249 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7253 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7254 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
7255 GC gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7256 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
7257 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, cursor_glyph
->face_id
);
7260 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7261 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7262 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7263 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7264 that the glyph is legible. */
7265 if (face
->background
== f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
7266 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= face
->foreground
;
7268 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7269 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= 0;
7272 XChangeGC (dpy
, gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7275 gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7276 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
= gc
;
7279 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7281 if (kind
== BAR_CURSOR
)
7283 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
7286 width
= FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f
);
7287 width
= min (cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
, width
);
7289 w
->phys_cursor_width
= width
;
7291 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7292 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7293 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0)
7294 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- width
;
7296 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
7297 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
),
7298 width
, row
->height
);
7302 int dummy_x
, dummy_y
, dummy_h
;
7305 width
= row
->height
;
7307 width
= min (row
->height
, width
);
7309 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &dummy_x
,
7310 &dummy_y
, &dummy_h
);
7312 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
,
7313 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
),
7314 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
+
7315 row
->height
- width
),
7316 w
->phys_cursor_width
, width
);
7319 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7324 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7327 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame
*f
, Cursor cursor
)
7329 if (!f
->pointer_invisible
7330 && f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
!= cursor
)
7331 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), cursor
);
7332 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
= cursor
;
7336 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7339 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
7341 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7342 x
, y
, width
, height
, False
);
7344 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7345 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
7346 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
7351 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7354 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*glyph_row
, int x
, int y
, int cursor_type
, int cursor_width
, int on_p
, int active_p
)
7356 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7360 w
->phys_cursor_type
= cursor_type
;
7361 w
->phys_cursor_on_p
= 1;
7363 if (glyph_row
->exact_window_width_line_p
7364 && (glyph_row
->reversed_p
7365 ? (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
< 0)
7366 : (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
>= glyph_row
->used
[TEXT_AREA
])))
7368 glyph_row
->cursor_in_fringe_p
= 1;
7369 draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, glyph_row
, glyph_row
->reversed_p
);
7373 switch (cursor_type
)
7375 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR
:
7376 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, glyph_row
);
7379 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR
:
7380 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, glyph_row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7384 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, BAR_CURSOR
);
7388 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, HBAR_CURSOR
);
7392 w
->phys_cursor_width
= 0;
7401 if (w
== XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
))
7402 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
))
7403 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, x
, y
);
7408 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
7415 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7418 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object file
)
7422 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7425 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7426 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7427 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7428 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7433 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7434 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7435 if (xg_set_icon (f
, file
))
7437 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7438 bitmap_id
= x_create_bitmap_from_file (f
, file
);
7439 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, bitmap_id
);
7443 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7444 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
< 0)
7450 if (xg_set_icon (f
, xg_default_icon_file
)
7451 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
))
7454 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7456 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
);
7458 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7462 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7465 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_data (f
, gnu_xbm_bits
,
7466 gnu_xbm_width
, gnu_xbm_height
);
7470 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7471 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7475 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7476 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7477 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7478 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7479 x_reference_bitmap (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7481 bitmap_id
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
;
7484 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, bitmap_id
);
7485 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= bitmap_id
;
7491 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7492 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7495 x_text_icon (struct frame
*f
, const char *icon_name
)
7497 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7502 text
.value
= (unsigned char *) icon_name
;
7503 text
.encoding
= XA_STRING
;
7505 text
.nitems
= strlen (icon_name
);
7506 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &text
);
7509 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7510 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7511 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7512 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, 0);
7517 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7519 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7520 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7522 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7523 be called from a signal handler.
7526 struct x_error_message_stack
{
7527 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7529 struct x_error_message_stack
*prev
;
7531 static struct x_error_message_stack
*x_error_message
;
7533 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7534 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7535 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7538 x_error_catcher (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*error
)
7540 XGetErrorText (display
, error
->error_code
,
7541 x_error_message
->string
,
7542 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7545 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7546 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7549 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7550 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7551 stored in *x_error_message.
7553 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7554 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7556 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7558 void x_check_errors (Display
*dpy
, const char *format
);
7561 x_catch_errors (Display
*dpy
)
7563 struct x_error_message_stack
*data
= xmalloc (sizeof (*data
));
7565 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7569 data
->string
[0] = 0;
7570 data
->prev
= x_error_message
;
7571 x_error_message
= data
;
7574 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7575 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7578 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7580 struct x_error_message_stack
*tmp
;
7584 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7585 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7586 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message
->dpy
) != 0)
7587 XSync (x_error_message
->dpy
, False
);
7589 tmp
= x_error_message
;
7590 x_error_message
= x_error_message
->prev
;
7595 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7596 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7597 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7600 x_check_errors (Display
*dpy
, const char *format
)
7602 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7605 if (x_error_message
->string
[0])
7607 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7608 memcpy (string
, x_error_message
->string
, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7609 x_uncatch_errors ();
7610 error (format
, string
);
7614 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7615 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7618 x_had_errors_p (Display
*dpy
)
7620 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7623 return x_error_message
->string
[0] != 0;
7626 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7629 x_clear_errors (Display
*dpy
)
7631 x_error_message
->string
[0] = 0;
7634 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7635 * idea. --lorentey */
7636 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7639 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7641 while (x_error_message
)
7642 x_uncatch_errors ();
7646 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7649 x_catching_errors (void)
7651 return x_error_message
!= 0;
7655 static unsigned int x_wire_count
;
7658 fprintf (stderr
, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count
);
7663 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7664 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7665 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7666 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7667 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7670 x_connection_signal (int signalnum
) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7671 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7674 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7675 must reestablish each time */
7676 signal (signalnum
, x_connection_signal
);
7681 /************************************************************************
7683 ************************************************************************/
7685 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7687 static char *error_msg
;
7689 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7690 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7691 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7694 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7696 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
7700 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7701 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7704 x_connection_closed (Display
*dpy
, const char *error_message
)
7706 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
7707 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7708 int index
= SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7710 error_msg
= (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message
) + 1);
7711 strcpy (error_msg
, error_message
);
7712 handling_signal
= 0;
7714 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7715 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7716 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7717 the original message here. */
7718 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
7720 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7721 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay
, Qt
);
7725 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7727 dpyinfo
->reference_count
++;
7728 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
++;
7731 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7732 that are on the dead display. */
7733 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7735 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame
;
7737 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame
))));
7738 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7739 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
))
7740 && ! EQ (frame
, minibuf_frame
)
7741 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7742 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
7745 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7746 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7747 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7748 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7749 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7750 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7752 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7753 trying to find a replacement. */
7754 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame
))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame
= Qt
;
7755 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
7758 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7759 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7762 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7763 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7764 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7765 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7767 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7768 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7769 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7771 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1',
7772 opened in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7774 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7775 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7776 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7777 fatal_error_signal_hook
= x_fatal_error_signal
;
7778 XtCloseDisplay (dpy
);
7779 fatal_error_signal_hook
= NULL
;
7780 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7783 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7784 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7785 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7786 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7787 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil
);
7788 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n\
7789 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7790 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7791 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7794 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7796 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7797 dpyinfo
->display
= 0;
7799 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
7800 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
--;
7801 if (dpyinfo
->reference_count
!= 0)
7802 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7807 XSETTERMINAL (tmp
, dpyinfo
->terminal
);
7808 Fdelete_terminal (tmp
, Qnoelisp
);
7812 x_uncatch_errors ();
7814 if (terminal_list
== 0)
7816 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
7817 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7821 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7823 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO
));
7825 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM
));
7826 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT
;
7828 unbind_to (index
, Qnil
);
7829 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7830 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7831 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7832 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7833 error ("%s", error_msg
);
7836 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7837 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7838 static void x_error_quitter (Display
*, XErrorEvent
*);
7840 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7841 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7844 x_error_handler (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*error
)
7846 if (x_error_message
)
7847 x_error_catcher (display
, error
);
7849 x_error_quitter (display
, error
);
7853 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7854 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7855 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7857 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7859 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7860 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7862 static void NO_INLINE
7863 x_error_quitter (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*error
)
7865 char buf
[256], buf1
[356];
7867 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7868 or colors that are not defined. */
7870 if (error
->error_code
== BadName
)
7873 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7874 original error handler. */
7876 XGetErrorText (display
, error
->error_code
, buf
, sizeof (buf
));
7877 sprintf (buf1
, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7878 buf
, error
->request_code
);
7879 x_connection_closed (display
, buf1
);
7883 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7884 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7885 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7888 x_io_error_quitter (Display
*display
)
7892 sprintf (buf
, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display
));
7893 x_connection_closed (display
, buf
);
7897 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7899 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7900 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7901 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7905 x_new_font (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object font_object
, int fontset
)
7907 struct font
*font
= XFONT_OBJECT (font_object
);
7910 fontset
= fontset_from_font (font_object
);
7911 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = fontset
;
7912 if (FRAME_FONT (f
) == font
)
7913 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7917 FRAME_FONT (f
) = font
;
7918 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f
) = font
->baseline_offset
;
7919 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) = font
->average_width
;
7920 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f
) = font
->space_width
;
7921 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) = FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
7923 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 1);
7925 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7926 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
7928 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
7929 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
)
7930 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) + wid
-1) / wid
;
7934 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
7935 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) = (14 + wid
- 1) / wid
;
7938 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) != 0)
7940 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7941 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7942 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7943 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
7944 x_set_window_size (f
, 0, FRAME_COLS (f
), FRAME_LINES (f
));
7949 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & (XIMPreeditPosition
| XIMStatusArea
)))
7952 xic_set_xfontset (f
, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
)));
7961 /***********************************************************************
7963 ***********************************************************************/
7969 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7970 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7971 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7974 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
7976 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) client_data
;
7977 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7981 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7982 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7984 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
7985 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
7987 FRAME_XIC (f
) = NULL
;
7988 xic_free_xfontset (f
);
7992 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7993 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
7994 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
7998 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8001 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8002 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM
, ...);
8005 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8006 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8009 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8017 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8018 xim
= XOpenIM (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, resource_name
,
8025 XIMCallback destroy
;
8028 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8029 XGetIMValues (xim
, XNQueryInputStyle
, &dpyinfo
->xim_styles
, NULL
);
8032 destroy
.callback
= xim_destroy_callback
;
8033 destroy
.client_data
= (XPointer
)dpyinfo
;
8034 XSetIMValues (xim
, XNDestroyCallback
, &destroy
, NULL
);
8040 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8041 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8045 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8047 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8048 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8049 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8050 when the callback was registered. */
8053 xim_instantiate_callback (Display
*display
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
8055 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) client_data
;
8056 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= xim_inst
->dpyinfo
;
8058 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8062 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8064 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8065 as they have no XIC. */
8066 if (dpyinfo
->xim
&& dpyinfo
->reference_count
> 0)
8068 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
8071 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8073 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8076 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == xim_inst
->dpyinfo
)
8077 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) == NULL
)
8079 create_frame_xic (f
);
8080 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
)
8081 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
8082 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
)
8084 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
);
8085 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, w
->cursor
.x
, w
->cursor
.y
);
8094 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8097 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8098 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8099 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8100 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8103 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8105 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8109 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8110 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
;
8113 xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t
));
8114 dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
= xim_inst
;
8115 xim_inst
->dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
;
8116 len
= strlen (resource_name
);
8117 xim_inst
->resource_name
= (char *) xmalloc (len
+ 1);
8118 memcpy (xim_inst
->resource_name
, resource_name
, len
+ 1);
8119 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8120 resource_name
, emacs_class
,
8121 xim_instantiate_callback
,
8122 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8123 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8124 least, hence the configure test. */
8125 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8126 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8127 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
8128 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8130 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8134 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8137 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
8142 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8143 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8144 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8146 xim_instantiate_callback
, NULL
);
8147 xfree (dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
->resource_name
);
8148 xfree (dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
);
8149 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8150 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8151 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8152 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8153 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8155 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8158 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8162 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8163 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8166 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame
*f
)
8168 int flags
= f
->size_hint_flags
;
8170 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8171 is already for the top-left corner. */
8172 if (! ((flags
& XNegative
) || (flags
& YNegative
)))
8175 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8176 position that fits on the screen. */
8177 if (flags
& XNegative
)
8178 f
->left_pos
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8179 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) + f
->left_pos
;
8182 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8184 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8185 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8186 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8188 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8189 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8190 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8191 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8194 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8195 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8197 XtVaGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->column_widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
8200 if (flags
& YNegative
)
8201 f
->top_pos
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8202 - height
+ f
->top_pos
;
8205 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8206 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8207 so the flags should correspond. */
8208 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8211 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8212 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8213 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8214 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8215 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8218 x_set_offset (struct frame
*f
, register int xoff
, register int yoff
, int change_gravity
)
8220 int modified_top
, modified_left
;
8222 if (change_gravity
> 0)
8224 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->left_before_move
= f
->left_pos
;
8225 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->top_before_move
= f
->top_pos
;
8229 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8231 f
->size_hint_flags
|= XNegative
;
8233 f
->size_hint_flags
|= YNegative
;
8234 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8236 x_calc_absolute_position (f
);
8239 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8241 modified_left
= f
->left_pos
;
8242 modified_top
= f
->top_pos
;
8244 if (change_gravity
!= 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
)
8246 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8247 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8248 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8249 modified_left
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8250 modified_top
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8253 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8254 modified_left
, modified_top
);
8256 x_sync_with_move (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
,
8257 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8260 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8261 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8262 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8263 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8266 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8267 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8268 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8270 if (change_gravity
!= 0 &&
8271 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8272 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
8273 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
== 0
8274 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
== 0))))
8275 x_check_expected_move (f
, modified_left
, modified_top
);
8280 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8281 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8282 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8283 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8284 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8287 wm_supports (struct frame
*f
, Atom want_atom
)
8290 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8291 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
8292 Window wmcheck_window
;
8293 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8294 Window target_window
= dpyinfo
->root_window
;
8295 long max_len
= 65536;
8296 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8297 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8298 Atom target_type
= XA_WINDOW
;
8302 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8303 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8304 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
,
8305 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8306 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8307 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8309 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_WINDOW
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8311 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8312 x_uncatch_errors ();
8317 wmcheck_window
= *(Window
*) tmp_data
;
8320 /* Check if window exists. */
8321 XSelectInput (dpy
, wmcheck_window
, StructureNotifyMask
);
8323 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8325 x_uncatch_errors ();
8330 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
!= wmcheck_window
)
8332 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8333 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
!= NULL
)
8334 XFree (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
);
8335 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
8336 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
8337 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
8339 target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8341 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8342 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
,
8343 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8344 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8345 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8347 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_ATOM
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8349 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8350 x_uncatch_errors ();
8355 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= (Atom
*)tmp_data
;
8356 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= actual_size
;
8357 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= wmcheck_window
;
8362 for (i
= 0; rc
== 0 && i
< dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
; ++i
)
8363 rc
= dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
[i
] == want_atom
;
8365 x_uncatch_errors ();
8372 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame
, int add
, Atom atom
, Atom value
)
8374 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
));
8376 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8377 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
8379 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8381 (make_number (add
? 1 : 0),
8383 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom
),
8385 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value
), Qnil
)
8390 x_set_sticky (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object new_value
, Lisp_Object old_value
)
8393 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8395 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8397 set_wm_state (frame
, NILP (new_value
) ? 0 : 1,
8398 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
, None
);
8401 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8402 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8403 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8406 get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*f
,
8412 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8413 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
8414 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8415 long max_len
= 65536;
8416 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8417 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8418 Atom target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8421 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8424 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8425 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, window
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
8426 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8427 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8428 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8430 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= target_type
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8432 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8433 x_uncatch_errors ();
8438 x_uncatch_errors ();
8440 for (i
= 0; i
< actual_size
; ++i
)
8442 Atom a
= ((Atom
*)tmp_data
)[i
];
8443 if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
8445 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
8446 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
8448 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
;
8450 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
8452 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
)
8453 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
8455 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
;
8457 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
8458 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_BOTH
;
8459 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
8463 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8467 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8470 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
8472 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8473 int have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
);
8476 get_current_wm_state (f
, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &cur
, &dummy
);
8478 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8479 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8481 have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
);
8483 if (have_net_atom
&& cur
!= f
->want_fullscreen
)
8487 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8489 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8490 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8491 are sent at once. */
8492 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8494 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8495 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8496 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
8497 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8498 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8499 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8501 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8502 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8503 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8504 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
8505 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8506 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8507 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
, None
);
8509 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8510 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8511 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8512 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
8513 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
);
8514 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8515 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
, None
);
8517 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8518 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8519 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8520 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8521 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8523 case FULLSCREEN_NONE
:
8524 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8525 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8527 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8528 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8531 f
->want_fullscreen
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8535 return have_net_atom
;
8539 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f
)
8541 if (f
->async_visible
)
8544 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
8552 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, XPropertyEvent
*event
)
8554 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8558 get_current_wm_state (f
, event
->window
, &value
, &sticky
);
8562 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8565 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8568 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8571 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8576 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
8577 store_frame_param (f
, Qsticky
, sticky
? Qt
: Qnil
);
8580 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8581 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8583 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
8585 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
))
8588 if (f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
!= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
8589 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8591 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8592 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8593 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8595 if (f
->want_fullscreen
!= FULLSCREEN_NONE
)
8597 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
), height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8598 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8600 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8602 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8603 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8604 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8605 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
8606 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
8608 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8609 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
8611 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8612 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
8615 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8620 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8621 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8622 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8623 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8624 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8625 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8626 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8629 x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*f
, int expected_left
, int expected_top
)
8631 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8633 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8634 window manager window around the frame. */
8636 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8638 if (current_left
!= expected_left
|| current_top
!= expected_top
)
8640 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8645 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_A
;
8646 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
= expected_left
- current_left
;
8647 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
= expected_top
- current_top
;
8649 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8651 adjusted_left
= expected_left
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8652 adjusted_top
= expected_top
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8654 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8655 adjusted_left
, adjusted_top
);
8657 x_sync_with_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
, 0);
8660 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8661 frame's position. */
8663 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_B
;
8667 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8668 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8669 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8670 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8671 of an exact comparison. */
8674 x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*f
, int left
, int top
, int fuzzy
)
8678 while (count
++ < 50)
8680 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8682 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8683 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8686 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8687 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8691 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8694 if (eabs (current_left
- left
) <= 10
8695 && eabs (current_top
- top
) <= 40)
8698 else if (current_left
== left
&& current_top
== top
)
8702 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8703 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8705 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil
, NULL
, 0);
8709 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8711 x_wait_for_event (struct frame
*f
, int eventtype
)
8713 int level
= interrupt_input_blocked
;
8716 EMACS_TIME tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
;
8717 int fd
= ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8719 pending_event_wait
.f
= f
;
8720 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= eventtype
;
8722 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8723 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8724 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo
, 0, 100000);
8725 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at
);
8726 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at
, tmo_at
, tmo
);
8728 while (pending_event_wait
.eventtype
)
8730 interrupt_input_pending
= 1;
8731 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT
;
8732 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8734 interrupt_input_blocked
= level
;
8739 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now
);
8740 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
);
8742 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo
) || select (fd
+1, &fds
, NULL
, NULL
, &tmo
) == 0)
8743 break; /* Timeout */
8745 pending_event_wait
.f
= 0;
8746 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0;
8750 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8751 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8752 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8753 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8756 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int cols
, int rows
)
8758 int pixelwidth
, pixelheight
;
8760 check_frame_size (f
, &rows
, &cols
);
8761 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8762 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
)
8764 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
8766 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 0);
8768 pixelwidth
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, cols
)
8769 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f
);
8770 pixelheight
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, rows
)
8771 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
8773 if (change_gravity
) f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8774 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8775 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8776 pixelwidth
, pixelheight
);
8779 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8780 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8781 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8782 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8783 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
8785 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8786 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8787 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8788 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8790 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8791 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8792 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8793 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8794 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8796 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8799 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8800 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8801 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8802 if (f
->async_visible
)
8803 x_wait_for_event (f
, ConfigureNotify
);
8806 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, cols
, 0, 1, 0);
8807 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = pixelwidth
;
8808 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = pixelheight
;
8814 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8815 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8816 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8817 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8820 x_set_window_size (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int cols
, int rows
)
8824 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
8828 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8829 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8830 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8831 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8832 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8833 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8834 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8835 int pixelh
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8837 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8839 pixelh
-= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
8841 r
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, pixelh
);
8842 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8843 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8844 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8845 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8846 c
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
));
8847 change_frame_size (f
, r
, c
, 0, 1, 0);
8851 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
8852 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, cols
, rows
);
8854 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8855 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8857 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8859 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8861 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8862 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f
->root_window
));
8864 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8865 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8866 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8867 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8868 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
8873 /* Mouse warping. */
8876 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
)
8880 pix_x
= FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f
, x
) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) / 2;
8881 pix_y
= FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f
, y
) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) / 2;
8883 if (pix_x
< 0) pix_x
= 0;
8884 if (pix_x
> FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)) pix_x
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
8886 if (pix_y
< 0) pix_y
= 0;
8887 if (pix_y
> FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
)) pix_y
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8891 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8892 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8896 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8899 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame
*f
, int pix_x
, int pix_y
)
8903 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8904 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8908 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8911 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8914 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8915 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8916 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8917 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8918 RevertToPointerRoot
, CurrentTime
);
8923 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8926 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8927 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_focus_frame
== f
)
8928 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), PointerRoot
,
8929 RevertToPointerRoot
, CurrentTime
);
8933 /* Raise frame F. */
8936 x_raise_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8939 if (f
->async_visible
)
8940 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8942 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8946 /* Lower frame F. */
8949 x_lower_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8951 if (f
->async_visible
)
8954 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8955 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8960 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8963 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f
)
8965 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8966 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8968 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8969 if (f
->async_visible
&& wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
))
8972 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8973 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8974 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
,
8976 Fcons (make_number (1),
8977 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time
),
8983 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f
, int raise_flag
)
8991 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8994 xembed_set_info (struct frame
*f
, enum xembed_info flags
)
8996 unsigned long data
[2];
8997 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8999 data
[0] = XEMBED_VERSION
;
9002 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9003 dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
,
9004 32, PropModeReplace
, (unsigned char *) data
, 2);
9008 xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time time
, enum xembed_message message
, long int detail
, long int data1
, long int data2
)
9012 event
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9013 event
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
;
9014 event
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_XEMBED
;
9015 event
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9016 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = time
;
9017 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1] = message
;
9018 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[2] = detail
;
9019 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[3] = data1
;
9020 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[4] = data2
;
9022 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
,
9023 False
, NoEventMask
, &event
);
9024 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
9027 /* Change of visibility. */
9029 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9030 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9031 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9032 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9033 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9034 finishes with it. */
9037 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame
*f
)
9040 int original_top
, original_left
;
9041 int retry_count
= 2;
9047 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9049 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9051 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9053 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9054 call x_set_offset a second time
9055 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9056 before the window gets really visible. */
9057 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9058 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9059 && ! f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
)
9060 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9062 f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
= 1;
9064 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9065 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, NormalState
);
9066 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9067 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9068 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9071 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9072 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9074 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9076 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9077 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9079 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9080 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9082 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9083 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9084 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9087 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9089 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9090 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9091 so that incoming events are handled. */
9095 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9096 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9097 will set it when they are handled. */
9098 int previously_visible
= f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
;
9100 original_left
= f
->left_pos
;
9101 original_top
= f
->top_pos
;
9103 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9106 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9108 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9109 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9110 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9111 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9113 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9114 because the window manager may choose the position
9115 and we don't want to override it. */
9117 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9118 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9119 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9120 && f
->win_gravity
== NorthWestGravity
9121 && previously_visible
)
9125 unsigned int width
, height
, border
, depth
;
9129 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9130 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9131 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9132 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9133 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9134 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9135 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9136 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9137 &rootw
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
, &border
, &depth
);
9139 if (original_left
!= x
|| original_top
!= y
)
9140 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9141 original_left
, original_top
);
9146 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9148 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9149 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9150 MapNotify at all.. */
9151 for (count
= input_signal_count
+ 10;
9152 input_signal_count
< count
&& !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);)
9154 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9157 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9158 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9159 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9160 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9161 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9163 if (input_polling_used ())
9165 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9166 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9167 handler reset it. */
9168 int old_poll_suppress_count
= poll_suppress_count
;
9169 poll_suppress_count
= 1;
9170 poll_for_input_1 ();
9171 poll_suppress_count
= old_poll_suppress_count
;
9174 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9175 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f
);
9180 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9184 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9185 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9186 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9187 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9189 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && --retry_count
> 0)
9194 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9196 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9199 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame
*f
)
9203 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9204 window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9206 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9207 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9208 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9212 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9213 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9214 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9215 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9216 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9217 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 1);
9220 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9221 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9224 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9225 xembed_set_info (f
, 0);
9230 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
,
9231 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))))
9233 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL
;
9234 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9238 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9239 just by the event that we get from the server.
9240 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9241 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9242 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9244 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
) = 0;
9245 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9246 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
9253 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9256 x_iconify_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9261 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9262 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9263 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9265 if (f
->async_iconified
)
9270 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f
);
9272 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9274 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9277 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9279 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9280 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9282 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9285 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9286 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9292 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9294 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9296 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9297 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9298 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9299 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9300 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9301 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9302 so we have to record it here. */
9305 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9306 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9311 result
= XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9312 XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
),
9313 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)));
9317 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9319 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9320 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9324 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9326 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9328 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9329 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9330 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9331 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9332 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9333 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9335 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9336 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9338 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9339 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9343 message
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9344 message
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9345 message
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_wm_change_state
;
9346 message
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9347 message
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = IconicState
;
9349 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9350 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)),
9352 SubstructureRedirectMask
| SubstructureNotifyMask
,
9355 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL
;
9356 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9360 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9362 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9364 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9366 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9367 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9370 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9371 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9373 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9375 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9379 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9382 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame
*f
)
9384 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9386 struct scroll_bar
*b
;
9387 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
9391 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9392 commands to the X server. */
9393 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
9395 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9396 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9398 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f
))
9399 free_frame_faces (f
);
9401 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
)
9402 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
);
9404 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9405 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9406 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9407 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9408 toolkit scroll bars. */
9409 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); !NILP (bar
); bar
= b
->next
)
9411 b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
9412 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
9421 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9422 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
9424 XtDestroyWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9425 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
= NULL
;
9427 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9428 we are using a toolkit. */
9429 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9430 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9432 free_frame_menubar (f
);
9433 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9436 xg_free_frame_widgets (f
);
9437 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9439 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9440 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9441 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9443 unload_color (f
, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9444 unload_color (f
, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9445 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
);
9446 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
);
9447 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
9448 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->mouse_pixel
);
9450 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
!= -1)
9451 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
);
9452 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
9453 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
9454 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9455 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9456 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9457 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
);
9458 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9459 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
);
9460 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9461 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.allocated_p
)
9462 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
);
9463 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.allocated_p
)
9464 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
);
9467 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9470 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
);
9471 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
);
9472 f
->output_data
.x
= NULL
;
9474 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
9475 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
9476 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
)
9477 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
9478 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
9479 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9481 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
9483 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
9484 = hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
9485 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
9486 = hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
9487 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
9488 hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
9489 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
9496 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9499 x_destroy_window (struct frame
*f
)
9501 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9503 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9504 commands to the X server. */
9505 if (dpyinfo
->display
!= 0)
9506 x_free_frame_resources (f
);
9508 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
9512 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9514 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9515 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9516 that the window now has.
9517 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9518 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9519 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9523 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame
*f
, long flags
, int user_position
)
9525 XSizeHints size_hints
;
9526 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9528 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9529 size_hints
.flags
= PResizeInc
| PMinSize
/* | PMaxSize */;
9531 size_hints
.x
= f
->left_pos
;
9532 size_hints
.y
= f
->top_pos
;
9534 size_hints
.height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9535 size_hints
.width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
9537 size_hints
.width_inc
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
9538 size_hints
.height_inc
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
9539 size_hints
.max_width
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
9540 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9541 size_hints
.max_height
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
9542 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9544 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9546 int base_width
, base_height
;
9547 int min_rows
= 0, min_cols
= 0;
9549 base_width
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9550 base_height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9552 check_frame_size (f
, &min_rows
, &min_cols
);
9554 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9555 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9556 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9557 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9558 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9560 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9561 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9562 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9564 size_hints
.flags
|= PBaseSize
;
9565 size_hints
.base_width
= base_width
;
9566 size_hints
.base_height
= base_height
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
9567 size_hints
.min_width
= base_width
+ min_cols
* size_hints
.width_inc
;
9568 size_hints
.min_height
= base_height
+ min_rows
* size_hints
.height_inc
;
9571 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9574 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9579 XSizeHints hints
; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9580 long supplied_return
;
9583 value
= XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &hints
,
9587 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9592 if (hints
.flags
& PSize
)
9593 size_hints
.flags
|= PSize
;
9594 if (hints
.flags
& PPosition
)
9595 size_hints
.flags
|= PPosition
;
9596 if (hints
.flags
& USPosition
)
9597 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9598 if (hints
.flags
& USSize
)
9599 size_hints
.flags
|= USSize
;
9606 size_hints
.win_gravity
= f
->win_gravity
;
9607 size_hints
.flags
|= PWinGravity
;
9611 size_hints
.flags
&= ~ PPosition
;
9612 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9614 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9616 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &size_hints
);
9618 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9620 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9623 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*f
, int state
)
9625 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9628 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNinitialState
, state
);
9629 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9630 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9631 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9633 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= StateHint
;
9634 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.initial_state
= state
;
9636 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9637 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9641 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*f
, int pixmap_id
)
9643 Pixmap icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
;
9645 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9646 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9651 icon_pixmap
= x_bitmap_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
);
9652 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= icon_pixmap
;
9653 icon_mask
= x_bitmap_mask (f
, pixmap_id
);
9654 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= icon_mask
;
9658 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9666 xg_set_frame_icon (f
, icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
);
9670 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9674 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconPixmap
, icon_pixmap
);
9675 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9676 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconMask
, icon_mask
);
9677 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9680 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9682 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= (IconPixmapHint
| IconMaskHint
);
9683 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9685 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9689 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame
*f
, int icon_x
, int icon_y
)
9691 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9693 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= IconPositionHint
;
9694 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_x
= icon_x
;
9695 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_y
= icon_y
;
9697 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9701 /***********************************************************************
9703 ***********************************************************************/
9707 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9711 x_check_font (struct frame
*f
, struct font
*font
)
9715 xassert (font
!= NULL
&& ! NILP (font
->props
[FONT_TYPE_INDEX
]));
9716 if (font
->driver
->check
)
9717 xassert (font
->driver
->check (f
, font
) == 0);
9720 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9723 /***********************************************************************
9725 ***********************************************************************/
9727 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9728 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options
[] = {
9729 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9730 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg
, (XtPointer
) "yes"},
9732 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9733 XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9734 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9736 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9737 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9738 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9739 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9740 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9741 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9742 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
}
9745 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9747 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
;
9749 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9751 static int x_initialized
;
9754 static int x_session_initialized
;
9757 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9758 the screen number from the server number. */
9760 same_x_server (const char *name1
, const char *name2
)
9763 const unsigned char *system_name
= SDATA (Vsystem_name
);
9764 int system_name_length
= strlen (system_name
);
9765 int length_until_period
= 0;
9767 while (system_name
[length_until_period
] != 0
9768 && system_name
[length_until_period
] != '.')
9769 length_until_period
++;
9771 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9772 if (! strncmp (name1
, "unix:", 5))
9774 if (! strncmp (name2
, "unix:", 5))
9776 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9777 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
9778 && name1
[system_name_length
] == ':')
9779 name1
+= system_name_length
;
9780 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
9781 && name2
[system_name_length
] == ':')
9782 name2
+= system_name_length
;
9783 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9784 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
9785 && name1
[length_until_period
] == ':')
9786 name1
+= length_until_period
;
9787 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
9788 && name2
[length_until_period
] == ':')
9789 name2
+= length_until_period
;
9791 for (; *name1
!= '\0' && *name1
== *name2
; name1
++, name2
++)
9795 if (seen_colon
&& *name1
== '.')
9799 && (*name1
== '.' || *name1
== '\0')
9800 && (*name2
== '.' || *name2
== '\0'));
9803 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9804 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9807 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask
, int *bits
, int *offset
)
9828 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9829 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9832 x_display_ok (const char *display
)
9837 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (display
);
9839 XCloseDisplay (dpy
);
9847 my_log_handler (const gchar
*log_domain
, GLogLevelFlags log_level
, const gchar
*message
, gpointer user_data
)
9849 if (!strstr (message
, "g_set_prgname"))
9850 fprintf (stderr
, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain
, message
);
9854 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9855 the structure that describes the open display.
9856 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9858 struct x_display_info
*
9859 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name
, char *xrm_option
, char *resource_name
)
9863 struct terminal
*terminal
;
9864 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
9866 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
;
9876 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name
)))
9877 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name
));
9883 char *argv
[NUM_ARGV
];
9884 char **argv2
= argv
;
9887 if (x_initialized
++ > 1)
9889 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name
), &dpy
);
9893 static char display_opt
[] = "--display";
9894 static char name_opt
[] = "--name";
9896 for (argc
= 0; argc
< NUM_ARGV
; ++argc
)
9900 argv
[argc
++] = initial_argv
[0];
9902 if (! NILP (display_name
))
9904 argv
[argc
++] = display_opt
;
9905 argv
[argc
++] = SDATA (display_name
);
9908 argv
[argc
++] = name_opt
;
9909 argv
[argc
++] = resource_name
;
9911 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9913 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9914 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9915 id
= g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING
| G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9916 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION
, my_log_handler
, NULL
);
9917 gtk_init (&argc
, &argv2
);
9918 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id
);
9920 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9924 dpy
= GDK_DISPLAY ();
9926 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9927 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL
, event_handler_gdk
, NULL
);
9929 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9931 const char *file
= "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9932 Lisp_Object s
, abs_file
;
9934 s
= make_string (file
, strlen (file
));
9935 abs_file
= Fexpand_file_name (s
, Qnil
);
9937 if (! NILP (abs_file
) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file
)))
9938 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file
));
9941 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
9942 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
9945 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9946 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9947 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9949 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9950 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9951 So let's not use it until R6. */
9953 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL
, NULL
, NULL
);
9964 argv
[argc
++] = "-xrm";
9965 argv
[argc
++] = xrm_option
;
9967 turn_on_atimers (0);
9968 dpy
= XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con
, SDATA (display_name
),
9969 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
9970 emacs_options
, XtNumber (emacs_options
),
9972 turn_on_atimers (1);
9975 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9980 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9981 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9982 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name
));
9983 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9984 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9986 /* Detect failure. */
9993 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9995 dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info
));
9996 memset (dpyinfo
, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo
);
9997 hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
9999 terminal
= x_create_terminal (dpyinfo
);
10002 struct x_display_info
*share
;
10005 for (share
= x_display_list
, tail
= x_display_name_list
; share
;
10006 share
= share
->next
, tail
= XCDR (tail
))
10007 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail
))),
10008 SDATA (display_name
)))
10011 terminal
->kboard
= share
->terminal
->kboard
;
10014 terminal
->kboard
= (KBOARD
*) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD
));
10015 init_kboard (terminal
->kboard
);
10016 terminal
->kboard
->Vwindow_system
= Qx
;
10018 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10019 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10020 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10021 terminal
->kboard
->next_kboard
= all_kboards
;
10022 all_kboards
= terminal
->kboard
;
10024 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
)->function
, Qunbound
))
10026 char *vendor
= ServerVendor (dpy
);
10028 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10029 list of terminals. */
10030 struct gcpro gcpro1
;
10031 Lisp_Object gcpro_term
;
10032 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term
, terminal
);
10033 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term
);
10035 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10036 terminal_list
= terminal
->next_terminal
;
10038 terminal
->kboard
->Vsystem_key_alist
10039 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
,
10040 vendor
? build_string (vendor
) : empty_unibyte_string
);
10042 terminal
->next_terminal
= terminal_list
;
10043 terminal_list
= terminal
;
10047 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10048 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10049 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10050 if (current_kboard
== initial_kboard
)
10051 current_kboard
= terminal
->kboard
;
10053 terminal
->kboard
->reference_count
++;
10056 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10057 dpyinfo
->next
= x_display_list
;
10058 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
;
10060 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10061 x_display_name_list
= Fcons (Fcons (display_name
, Qnil
),
10062 x_display_name_list
);
10063 dpyinfo
->name_list_element
= XCAR (x_display_name_list
);
10065 dpyinfo
->display
= dpy
;
10067 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10068 terminal
->name
= (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name
) + 1);
10069 strncpy (terminal
->name
, SDATA (display_name
), SBYTES (display_name
));
10070 terminal
->name
[SBYTES (display_name
)] = 0;
10073 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display
, x_trace_wire
);
10077 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
)
10078 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name
)
10080 sprintf (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
, "%s@%s",
10081 SDATA (Vinvocation_name
), SDATA (Vsystem_name
));
10083 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10084 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
10086 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10088 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10089 dpyinfo
->xg_cursor
= xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo
->display
);
10090 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10092 dpyinfo
->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10093 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_v_double_arrow
);
10095 xrdb
= x_load_resources (dpyinfo
->display
, xrm_option
,
10096 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
);
10097 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10098 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, xrdb
);
10100 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= xrdb
;
10102 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10104 dpyinfo
->xrdb
= xrdb
;
10106 dpyinfo
->screen
= ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
,
10107 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo
->display
));
10108 select_visual (dpyinfo
);
10109 dpyinfo
->cmap
= DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10110 dpyinfo
->root_window
= RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10111 dpyinfo
->client_leader_window
= 0;
10112 dpyinfo
->grabbed
= 0;
10113 dpyinfo
->reference_count
= 0;
10114 dpyinfo
->icon_bitmap_id
= -1;
10115 dpyinfo
->n_fonts
= 0;
10116 dpyinfo
->bitmaps
= 0;
10117 dpyinfo
->bitmaps_size
= 0;
10118 dpyinfo
->bitmaps_last
= 0;
10119 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= 0;
10120 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
10121 hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
10122 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
10123 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
10124 hlinfo
->mouse_face_face_id
= DEFAULT_FACE_ID
;
10125 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
10126 hlinfo
->mouse_face_overlay
= Qnil
;
10127 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_x
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_y
= 0;
10128 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
10129 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
10130 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
10131 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
10132 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
10133 dpyinfo
->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
10135 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10136 dpyinfo
->red_bits
= dpyinfo
->blue_bits
= dpyinfo
->green_bits
= 0;
10137 dpyinfo
->red_offset
= dpyinfo
->blue_offset
= dpyinfo
->green_offset
= 0;
10139 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == TrueColor
)
10141 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->red_mask
,
10142 &dpyinfo
->red_bits
, &dpyinfo
->red_offset
);
10143 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->blue_mask
,
10144 &dpyinfo
->blue_bits
, &dpyinfo
->blue_offset
);
10145 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->green_mask
,
10146 &dpyinfo
->green_bits
, &dpyinfo
->green_offset
);
10149 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10150 if (dpyinfo
->visual
== DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
))
10152 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == PseudoColor
)
10155 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10156 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10157 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10159 if (STRINGP (value
)
10160 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "true")
10161 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "on")))
10162 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->cmap
);
10166 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCreateColormap (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10167 dpyinfo
->visual
, AllocNone
);
10171 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10172 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10173 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10174 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10175 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10177 char *v
= XGetDefault (dpyinfo
->display
, "Xft", "dpi");
10179 if (v
!= NULL
&& sscanf (v
, "%lf", &d
) == 1)
10180 dpyinfo
->resy
= dpyinfo
->resx
= d
;
10184 if (dpyinfo
->resy
< 1)
10186 int screen_number
= XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10187 double pixels
= DisplayHeight (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10188 double mm
= DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10189 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10190 dpyinfo
->resy
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10191 pixels
= DisplayWidth (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10192 mm
= DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10193 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10194 dpyinfo
->resx
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10203 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
},
10204 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
},
10205 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
},
10206 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
},
10207 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_change_state
},
10208 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
},
10209 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
},
10210 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_client_leader
},
10211 { "Editres", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
},
10212 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
},
10213 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
},
10214 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_TEXT
},
10215 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
},
10216 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
},
10217 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_DELETE
},
10218 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULTIPLE
},
10219 { "INCR", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_INCR
},
10220 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
},
10221 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_TARGETS
},
10222 { "NULL", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_NULL
},
10223 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
},
10224 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
},
10225 /* For properties of font. */
10226 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
},
10227 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
},
10228 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
},
10229 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
},
10230 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
},
10231 /* Ghostscript support. */
10232 { "DONE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
},
10233 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
},
10234 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
},
10235 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
},
10237 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
},
10238 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
},
10239 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10240 &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
},
10241 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10242 &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
},
10243 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
},
10244 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_window_type
},
10245 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10246 &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
},
10247 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
},
10248 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_name
},
10249 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
},
10250 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
},
10251 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
},
10252 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
},
10253 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_frame_extents
},
10254 /* Session management */
10255 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID
},
10256 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_prop
},
10257 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_mgr
},
10261 const int atom_count
= sizeof (atom_refs
) / sizeof (atom_refs
[0]);
10262 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10263 const int total_atom_count
= 1 + atom_count
;
10264 Atom
*atoms_return
= xmalloc (sizeof (Atom
) * total_atom_count
);
10265 char **atom_names
= xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count
);
10266 char xsettings_atom_name
[64];
10268 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
10269 atom_names
[i
] = (char *) atom_refs
[i
].name
;
10271 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10272 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name
, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name
),
10273 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
));
10274 atom_names
[i
] = xsettings_atom_name
;
10276 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo
->display
, atom_names
, total_atom_count
,
10277 False
, atoms_return
);
10279 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
10280 *atom_refs
[i
].atom
= atoms_return
[i
];
10282 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10283 dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_sel
= atoms_return
[i
];
10285 xfree (atom_names
);
10286 xfree (atoms_return
);
10289 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
= 8;
10290 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_length
= 0;
10291 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
= xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
)
10292 * dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
);
10294 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
10295 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
10296 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
10298 connection
= ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo
->display
);
10299 dpyinfo
->connection
= connection
;
10303 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10305 gray_bitmap_width
, gray_bitmap_height
,
10306 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10310 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
10313 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo
);
10315 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10316 if (connection
!= 0)
10317 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection
);
10320 fcntl (connection
, F_SETOWN
, getpid ());
10321 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10324 if (interrupt_input
)
10325 init_sigio (connection
);
10326 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10330 Display
*dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
10331 XrmValue d
, fr
, to
;
10334 d
.addr
= (XPointer
)&dpy
;
10335 d
.size
= sizeof (Display
*);
10336 fr
.addr
= XtDefaultFont
;
10337 fr
.size
= sizeof (XtDefaultFont
);
10338 to
.size
= sizeof (Font
*);
10339 to
.addr
= (XPointer
)&font
;
10340 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
10341 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy
, XtCvtStringToFont
, &d
, 1, &fr
, &to
, NULL
))
10343 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
) || !XQueryFont (dpy
, font
))
10344 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb
, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10345 x_uncatch_errors ();
10349 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10350 for debugging X code. */
10353 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10354 build_string ("synchronous"),
10355 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10357 if (STRINGP (value
)
10358 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "true")
10359 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "on")))
10360 XSynchronize (dpyinfo
->display
, True
);
10365 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10366 build_string ("useXIM"),
10367 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10370 if (STRINGP (value
)
10371 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "false")
10372 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "off")))
10375 if (STRINGP (value
)
10376 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value
), "true")
10377 || !strcmp (SDATA (value
), "on")))
10383 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10384 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10386 if (terminal
->id
== 1)
10387 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo
);
10395 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10396 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10399 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10401 struct terminal
*t
;
10403 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10405 for (t
= terminal_list
; t
; t
= t
->next_terminal
)
10406 if (t
->type
== output_x_window
&& t
->display_info
.x
== dpyinfo
)
10409 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10410 if (t
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10411 x_session_close ();
10413 delete_terminal (t
);
10417 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
10419 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10420 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10421 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list
)
10422 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list
), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
10423 x_display_name_list
= XCDR (x_display_name_list
);
10428 tail
= x_display_name_list
;
10429 while (CONSP (tail
) && CONSP (XCDR (tail
)))
10431 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail
)), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
10433 XSETCDR (tail
, XCDR (XCDR (tail
)));
10436 tail
= XCDR (tail
);
10440 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== dpyinfo
)
10441 next_noop_dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
;
10443 if (x_display_list
== dpyinfo
)
10444 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
->next
;
10447 struct x_display_info
*tail
;
10449 for (tail
= x_display_list
; tail
; tail
= tail
->next
)
10450 if (tail
->next
== dpyinfo
)
10451 tail
->next
= tail
->next
->next
;
10454 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
);
10455 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
);
10456 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
10460 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10462 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10463 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10464 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10465 that slows us down. */
10468 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer
*timer
)
10471 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 0;
10472 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
|| popup_activated ())
10474 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con
) & XtIMTimer
)
10475 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con
, XtIMTimer
);
10476 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10477 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10482 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10483 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10484 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10485 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10486 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10487 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10488 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10491 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10494 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
)
10496 EMACS_TIME interval
;
10498 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval
, 0, 100000);
10499 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE
, interval
, x_process_timeouts
, 0);
10500 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 1;
10505 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10508 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10510 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers
[];
10512 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface
=
10514 x_frame_parm_handlers
,
10518 x_clear_end_of_line
,
10520 x_after_update_window_line
,
10521 x_update_window_begin
,
10522 x_update_window_end
,
10528 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10530 x_clear_window_mouse_face
,
10531 x_get_glyph_overhangs
,
10532 x_fix_overlapping_area
,
10533 x_draw_fringe_bitmap
,
10534 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10535 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10536 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
,
10537 x_draw_glyph_string
,
10538 x_define_frame_cursor
,
10539 x_clear_frame_area
,
10540 x_draw_window_cursor
,
10541 x_draw_vertical_window_border
,
10542 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10546 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10548 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*terminal
)
10550 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
10552 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10553 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10554 if (!terminal
->name
)
10559 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10562 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
);
10565 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10566 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10567 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
10569 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo
);
10570 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo
->display
, DestroyAll
);
10572 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10573 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10574 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10575 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10577 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10578 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10579 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10580 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10581 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10582 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10583 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10584 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10585 leaks in other situations. */
10587 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10588 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, NULL
);
10590 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= NULL
;
10592 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10593 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10594 closing all the displays. */
10595 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo
->xrdb
);
10599 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
10601 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10602 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
10604 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
10606 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10609 /* Mark as dead. */
10610 dpyinfo
->display
= NULL
;
10611 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
10615 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10616 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10618 static struct terminal
*
10619 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10621 struct terminal
*terminal
;
10623 terminal
= create_terminal ();
10625 terminal
->type
= output_x_window
;
10626 terminal
->display_info
.x
= dpyinfo
;
10627 dpyinfo
->terminal
= terminal
;
10629 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10631 terminal
->clear_frame_hook
= x_clear_frame
;
10632 terminal
->ins_del_lines_hook
= x_ins_del_lines
;
10633 terminal
->delete_glyphs_hook
= x_delete_glyphs
;
10634 terminal
->ring_bell_hook
= XTring_bell
;
10635 terminal
->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook
= XTtoggle_invisible_pointer
;
10636 terminal
->reset_terminal_modes_hook
= XTreset_terminal_modes
;
10637 terminal
->set_terminal_modes_hook
= XTset_terminal_modes
;
10638 terminal
->update_begin_hook
= x_update_begin
;
10639 terminal
->update_end_hook
= x_update_end
;
10640 terminal
->set_terminal_window_hook
= XTset_terminal_window
;
10641 terminal
->read_socket_hook
= XTread_socket
;
10642 terminal
->frame_up_to_date_hook
= XTframe_up_to_date
;
10643 terminal
->mouse_position_hook
= XTmouse_position
;
10644 terminal
->frame_rehighlight_hook
= XTframe_rehighlight
;
10645 terminal
->frame_raise_lower_hook
= XTframe_raise_lower
;
10646 terminal
->fullscreen_hook
= XTfullscreen_hook
;
10647 terminal
->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_vertical_scroll_bar
;
10648 terminal
->condemn_scroll_bars_hook
= XTcondemn_scroll_bars
;
10649 terminal
->redeem_scroll_bar_hook
= XTredeem_scroll_bar
;
10650 terminal
->judge_scroll_bars_hook
= XTjudge_scroll_bars
;
10652 terminal
->delete_frame_hook
= x_destroy_window
;
10653 terminal
->delete_terminal_hook
= x_delete_terminal
;
10655 terminal
->rif
= &x_redisplay_interface
;
10656 terminal
->scroll_region_ok
= 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10657 terminal
->char_ins_del_ok
= 1;
10658 terminal
->line_ins_del_ok
= 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10659 terminal
->fast_clear_end_of_line
= 1; /* X does this well. */
10660 terminal
->memory_below_frame
= 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10667 x_initialize (void)
10672 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
10673 any_help_event_p
= 0;
10674 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
10676 x_session_initialized
= 0;
10680 current_count
= -1;
10683 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10684 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt
);
10686 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10687 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10689 Xt_app_con
= XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10691 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10692 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10693 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con
,
10694 XtRString
, XtRPixel
, cvt_string_to_pixel
,
10695 cvt_string_to_pixel_args
,
10696 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args
),
10697 XtCacheByDisplay
, cvt_pixel_dtor
);
10699 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con
, Xt_default_resources
);
10702 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10704 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= False
;
10705 xaw3d_pick_top
= True
;
10709 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
10710 pending_event_wait
.f
= 0;
10711 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0;
10713 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10714 original error handler. */
10715 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
10716 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
10718 signal (SIGPIPE
, x_connection_signal
);
10720 xgselect_initialize ();
10725 syms_of_xterm (void)
10727 x_error_message
= NULL
;
10729 staticpro (&x_display_name_list
);
10730 x_display_name_list
= Qnil
;
10732 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
10733 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
10735 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms
);
10736 Qvendor_specific_keysyms
= intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10738 staticpro (&Qlatin_1
);
10739 Qlatin_1
= intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10741 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame
);
10742 last_mouse_press_frame
= Qnil
;
10745 xg_default_icon_file
= make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10746 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file
);
10748 Qx_gtk_map_stock
= intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10749 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock
);
10752 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10753 x_use_underline_position_properties
,
10754 doc
: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10755 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10756 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10757 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10758 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10760 x_use_underline_position_properties
= 1;
10762 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10763 x_underline_at_descent_line
,
10764 doc
: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10765 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10766 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10767 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10768 x_underline_at_descent_line
= 0;
10770 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10771 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
,
10772 doc
: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10773 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10774 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10775 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10776 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10777 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10778 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
= 0;
10780 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
,
10781 doc
: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10782 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10783 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10784 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10785 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10786 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10788 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("motif");
10789 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10790 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10792 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("gtk");
10794 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw");
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= Qnil
;
10800 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame
);
10801 last_mouse_motion_frame
= Qnil
;
10803 Qmodifier_value
= intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10804 Qalt
= intern_c_string ("alt");
10805 Fput (Qalt
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (alt_modifier
));
10806 Qhyper
= intern_c_string ("hyper");
10807 Fput (Qhyper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (hyper_modifier
));
10808 Qmeta
= intern_c_string ("meta");
10809 Fput (Qmeta
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (meta_modifier
));
10810 Qsuper
= intern_c_string ("super");
10811 Fput (Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (super_modifier
));
10813 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym
,
10814 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10815 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10816 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10817 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10818 Vx_alt_keysym
= Qnil
;
10820 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym
,
10821 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10822 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10823 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10824 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10825 Vx_hyper_keysym
= Qnil
;
10827 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym
,
10828 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10829 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10830 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10831 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10832 Vx_meta_keysym
= Qnil
;
10834 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym
,
10835 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10836 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10837 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10838 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10839 Vx_super_keysym
= Qnil
;
10841 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table
,
10842 doc
: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10843 Vx_keysym_table
= make_hash_table (Qeql
, make_number (900),
10844 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE
),
10845 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD
),
10849 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */